The Life and Adventures of Robinson Crusoe
The
Life and Adventures
of
Robinson Crusoe
By
Daniel Defoe
3/1
CHAPTER VIII.
SURVEYS HIS POSITION
I mentioned before that I had a great mind
to see the whole island, and that I had travelled up the brook, and so on to
where I built my bower, and where I had an opening quite to the sea, on the
other side of the island. I now resolved to travel quite across to the
sea-shore on that side; so, taking my gun, a hatchet, and my dog, and a larger
quantity of powder and shot than usual, with two biscuit-cakes and a great
bunch of raisins in my pouch for my store, I began my journey. When I had
passed the vale where my bower stood, as above, I came within view of the sea
to the west, and it being a very clear day, I fairly descried land—whether an
island or a continent I could not tell; but it lay very high, extending from
the W. to the W.S.W. at a very great distance; by my guess it could not be less
than fifteen or twenty leagues off.
I could not tell what part of the world
this might be, otherwise than that I knew it must be part of America, and, as I
concluded by all my observations, must be near the Spanish dominions, and
perhaps was all inhabited by savages, where, if I had landed, I had been in a
worse condition than I was now; and therefore I acquiesced in the dispositions
of Providence, which I began now to own and to believe ordered everything for
the best; I say I quieted my mind with this, and left off afflicting myself
with fruitless wishes of being there.
Besides, after some thought upon this
affair, I considered that if this land was the Spanish coast, I should
certainly, one time or other, see some vessel pass or repass one way or other;
but if not, then it was the savage coast between the Spanish country and
Brazils, where are found the worst of savages; for they are cannibals or
men-eaters, and fail not to murder and devour all the human bodies that fall
into their hands.
With these considerations, I walked very
leisurely forward. I found that side of the island where I now was much pleasanter
than mine—the open or savannah fields sweet, adorned with flowers and grass,
and full of very fine woods. I saw abundance of parrots, and fain I would have
caught one, if possible, to have kept it to be tame, and taught it to speak to
me. I did, after some painstaking, catch a young parrot, for I knocked it down
with a stick, and having recovered it, I brought it home; but it was some years
before I could make him speak; however, at last I taught him to call me by name
very familiarly. But the accident that followed, though it be a trifle, will be
very diverting in its place.
I was exceedingly diverted with this
journey. I found in the low grounds hares (as I thought them to be) and foxes;
but they differed greatly from all the other kinds I had met with, nor could I
satisfy myself to eat them, though I killed several. But I had no need to be
venturous, for I had no want of food, and of that which was very good too,
especially these three sorts, viz. goats, pigeons, and turtle, or tortoise,
which added to my grapes, Leadenhall market could not have furnished a table
better than I, in proportion to the company; and though my case was deplorable
enough, yet I had great cause for thankfulness that I was not driven to any
extremities for food, but had rather plenty, even to dainties.
I never travelled in this journey above
two miles outright in a day, or thereabouts; but I took so many turns and
re-turns to see what discoveries I could make, that I came weary enough to the
place where I resolved to sit down all night; and then I either reposed myself
in a tree, or surrounded myself with a row of stakes set upright in the ground,
either from one tree to another, or so as no wild creature could come at me
without waking me.
As soon as I came to the sea-shore, I was
surprised to see that I had taken up my lot on the worst side of the island,
for here, indeed, the shore was covered with innumerable turtles, whereas on
the other side I had found but three in a year and a half. Here was also an
infinite number of fowls of many kinds, some which I had seen, and some which I
had not seen before, and many of them very good meat, but such as I knew not
the names of, except those called penguins.
I could have shot as many as I pleased,
but was very sparing of my powder and shot, and therefore had more mind to kill
a she-goat if I could, which I could better feed on; and though there were many
goats here, more than on my side the island, yet it was with much more
difficulty that I could come near them, the country being flat and even, and
they saw me much sooner than when I was on the hills.
I confess this side of the country was
much pleasanter than mine; but yet I had not the least inclination to remove,
for as I was fixed in my habitation it became natural to me, and I seemed all
the while I was here to be as it were upon a journey, and from home. However, I
travelled along the shore of the sea towards the east, I suppose about twelve
miles, and then setting up a great pole upon the shore for a mark, I concluded
I would go home again, and that the next journey I took should be on the other
side of the island east from my dwelling, and so round till I came to my post
again.
I took another way to come back than that
I went, thinking I could easily keep all the island so much in my view that I
could not miss finding my first dwelling by viewing the country; but I found
myself mistaken, for being come about two or three miles, I found myself
descended into a very large valley, but so surrounded with hills, and those
hills covered with wood, that I could not see which was my way by any direction
but that of the sun, nor even then, unless I knew very well the position of the
sun at that time of the day. It happened, to my further misfortune, that the
weather proved hazy for three or four days while I was in the valley, and not
being able to see the sun, I wandered about very uncomfortably, and at last was
obliged to find the seaside, look for my post, and come back the same way I
went: and then, by easy journeys, I turned homeward, the weather being
exceeding hot, and my gun, ammunition, hatchet, and other things very heavy.
In this journey my dog surprised a young
kid, and seized upon it; and I, running in to take hold of it, caught it, and
saved it alive from the dog. I had a great mind to bring it home if I could,
for I had often been musing whether it might not be possible to get a kid or
two, and so raise a breed of tame goats, which might supply me when my powder
and shot should be all spent. I made a collar for this little creature, and
with a string, which I made of some rope-yarn, which I always carried about me,
I led him along, though with some difficulty, till I came to my bower, and
there I enclosed him and left him, for I was very impatient to be at home, from
whence I had been absent above a month.
I cannot express what a satisfaction it
was to me to come into my old hutch, and lie down in my hammock-bed. This
little wandering journey, without settled place of abode, had been so
unpleasant to me, that my own house, as I called it to myself, was a perfect
settlement to me compared to that; and it rendered everything about me so
comfortable, that I resolved I would never go a great way from it again while
it should be my lot to stay on the island.
I reposed myself here a week, to rest and
regale myself after my long journey; during which most of the time was taken up
in the weighty affair of making a cage for my Poll, who began now to be a mere
domestic, and to be well acquainted with me. Then I began to think of the poor
kid which I had penned in within my little circle, and resolved to go and fetch
it home, or give it some food; accordingly I went, and found it where I left
it, for indeed it could not get out, but was almost starved for want of food. I
went and cut boughs of trees, and branches of such shrubs as I could find, and
threw it over, and having fed it, I tied it as I did before, to lead it away;
but it was so tame with being hungry, that I had no need to have tied it, for
it followed me like a dog: and as I continually fed it, the creature became so
loving, so gentle, and so fond, that it became from that time one of my
domestics also, and would never leave me afterwards.
The rainy season of the autumnal equinox
was now come, and I kept the 30th of September in the same solemn manner as
before, being the anniversary of my landing on the island, having now been
there two years, and no more prospect of being delivered than the first day I
came there, I spent the whole day in humble and thankful acknowledgments of the
many wonderful mercies which my solitary condition was attended with, and
without which it might have been infinitely more miserable. I gave humble and
hearty thanks that God had been pleased to discover to me that it was possible
I might be more happy in this solitary condition than I should have been in the
liberty of society, and in all the pleasures of the world; that He could fully
make up to me the deficiencies of my solitary state, and the want of human
society, by His presence and the communications of His grace to my soul;
supporting, comforting, and encouraging me to depend upon His providence here,
and hope for His eternal presence hereafter.
It was now that I began sensibly to feel
how much more happy this life I now led was, with all its miserable circumstances,
than the wicked, cursed, abominable life I led all the past part of my days;
and now I changed both my sorrows and my joys; my very desires altered, my
affections changed their gusts, and my delights were perfectly new from what
they were at my first coming, or, indeed, for the two years past.
Before, as I walked about, either on my
hunting or for viewing the country, the anguish of my soul at my condition
would break out upon me on a sudden, and my very heart would die within me, to
think of the woods, the mountains, the deserts I was in, and how I was a
prisoner, locked up with the eternal bars and bolts of the ocean, in an
uninhabited wilderness, without redemption. In the midst of the greatest
composure of my mind, this would break out upon me like a storm, and make me
wring my hands and weep like a child. Sometimes it would take me in the middle
of my work, and I would immediately sit down and sigh, and look upon the ground
for an hour or two together; and this was still worse to me, for if I could
burst out into tears, or vent myself by words, it would go off, and the grief,
having exhausted itself, would abate.
But now I began to exercise myself with
new thoughts: I daily read the word of God, and applied all the comforts of it
to my present state. One morning, being very sad, I opened the Bible upon these
words, “I will never, never leave thee, nor forsake thee.” Immediately it
occurred that these words were to me; why else should they be directed in such
a manner, just at the moment when I was mourning over my condition, as one
forsaken of God and man? “Well, then,” said I, “if God does not forsake me, of
what ill consequence can it be, or what matters it, though the world should all
forsake me, seeing on the other hand, if I had all the world, and should lose
the favour and blessing of God, there would be no comparison in the loss?”
From this moment I began to conclude in my
mind that it was possible for me to be more happy in this forsaken, solitary
condition than it was probable I should ever have been in any other particular
state in the world; and with this thought I was going to give thanks to God for
bringing me to this place. I know not what it was, but something shocked my
mind at that thought, and I durst not speak the words. “How canst thou become
such a hypocrite,” said I, even audibly, “to pretend to be thankful for a
condition which, however thou mayest endeavour to be contented with, thou
wouldst rather pray heartily to be delivered from?” So I stopped there; but
though I could not say I thanked God for being there, yet I sincerely gave
thanks to God for opening my eyes, by whatever afflicting providences, to see
the former condition of my life, and to mourn for my wickedness, and repent. I
never opened the Bible, or shut it, but my very soul within me blessed God for
directing my friend in England, without any order of mine, to pack it up among
my goods, and for assisting me afterwards to save it out of the wreck of the
ship.
Thus, and in this disposition of mind, I
began my third year; and though I have not given the reader the trouble of so
particular an account of my works this year as the first, yet in general it may
be observed that I was very seldom idle, but having regularly divided my time
according to the several daily employments that were before me, such as: first,
my duty to God, and the reading the Scriptures, which I constantly set apart
some time for thrice every day; secondly, the going abroad with my gun for
food, which generally took me up three hours in every morning, when it did not
rain; thirdly, the ordering, cutting, preserving, and cooking what I had killed
or caught for my supply; these took up great part of the day. Also, it is to be
considered, that in the middle of the day, when the sun was in the zenith, the
violence of the heat was too great to stir out; so that about four hours in the
evening was all the time I could be supposed to work in, with this exception,
that sometimes I changed my hours of hunting and working, and went to work in
the morning, and abroad with my gun in the afternoon.
To this short time allowed for labour I
desire may be added the exceeding laboriousness of my work; the many hours
which, for want of tools, want of help, and want of skill, everything I did
took up out of my time. For example, I was full two and forty days in making a
board for a long shelf, which I wanted in my cave; whereas, two sawyers, with
their tools and a saw-pit, would have cut six of them out of the same tree in
half a day.
My case was this: it was to be a large
tree which was to be cut down, because my board was to be a broad one. This
tree I was three days in cutting down, and two more cutting off the boughs, and
reducing it to a log or piece of timber. With inexpressible hacking and hewing
I reduced both the sides of it into chips till it began to be light enough to
move; then I turned it, and made one side of it smooth and flat as a board from
end to end; then, turning that side downward, cut the other side til I brought
the plank to be about three inches thick, and smooth on both sides. Any one may
judge the labour of my hands in such a piece of work; but labour and patience
carried me through that, and many other things. I only observe this in
particular, to show the reason why so much of my time went away with so little
work—viz. that what might be a little to be done with help and tools, was a
vast labour and required a prodigious time to do alone, and by hand. But
notwithstanding this, with patience and labour I got through everything that my
circumstances made necessary to me to do, as will appear by what follows.
I was now, in the months of November and
December, expecting my crop of barley and rice. The ground I had manured and
dug up for them was not great; for, as I observed, my seed of each was not
above the quantity of half a peck, for I had lost one whole crop by sowing in
the dry season. But now my crop promised very well, when on a sudden I found I
was in danger of losing it all again by enemies of several sorts, which it was
scarcely possible to keep from it; as, first, the goats, and wild creatures
which I called hares, who, tasting the sweetness of the blade, lay in it night
and day, as soon as it came up, and eat it so close, that it could get no time
to shoot up into stalk.
This I saw no remedy for but by making an
enclosure about it with a hedge; which I did with a great deal of toil, and the
more, because it required speed. However, as my arable land was but small,
suited to my crop, I got it totally well fenced in about three weeks’ time; and
shooting some of the creatures in the daytime, I set my dog to guard it in the
night, tying him up to a stake at the gate, where he would stand and bark all
night long; so in a little time the enemies forsook the place, and the corn
grew very strong and well, and began to ripen apace.
But as the beasts ruined me before, while
my corn was in the blade, so the birds were as likely to ruin me now, when it
was in the ear; for, going along by the place to see how it throve, I saw my
little crop surrounded with fowls, of I know not how many sorts, who stood, as
it were, watching till I should be gone. I immediately let fly among them, for
I always had my gun with me. I had no sooner shot, but there rose up a little
cloud of fowls, which I had not seen at all, from among the corn itself.
This touched me sensibly, for I foresaw
that in a few days they would devour all my hopes; that I should be starved,
and never be able to raise a crop at all; and what to do I could not tell;
however, I resolved not to lose my corn, if possible, though I should watch it
night and day. In the first place, I went among it to see what damage was
already done, and found they had spoiled a good deal of it; but that as it was
yet too green for them, the loss was not so great but that the remainder was
likely to be a good crop if it could be saved.
I stayed by it to load my gun, and then
coming away, I could easily see the thieves sitting upon all the trees about
me, as if they only waited till I was gone away, and the event proved it to be
so; for as I walked off, as if I was gone, I was no sooner out of their sight
than they dropped down one by one into the corn again. I was so provoked, that
I could not have patience to stay till more came on, knowing that every grain
that they ate now was, as it might be said, a peck-loaf to me in the
consequence; but coming up to the hedge, I fired again, and killed three of
them. This was what I wished for; so I took them up, and served them as we
serve notorious thieves in England—hanged them in chains, for a terror to
others. It is impossible to imagine that this should have such an effect as it
had, for the fowls would not only not come at the corn, but, in short, they
forsook all that part of the island, and I could never see a bird near the place
as long as my scarecrows hung there. This I was very glad of, you may be sure,
and about the latter end of December, which was our second harvest of the year,
I reaped my corn.
I was sadly put to it for a scythe or
sickle to cut it down, and all I could do was to make one, as well as I could,
out of one of the broadswords, or cutlasses, which I saved among the arms out
of the ship. However, as my first crop was but small, I had no great difficulty
to cut it down; in short, I reaped it in my way, for I cut nothing off but the
ears, and carried it away in a great basket which I had made, and so rubbed it
out with my hands; and at the end of all my harvesting, I found that out of my
half-peck of seed I had near two bushels of rice, and about two bushels and a half
of barley; that is to say, by my guess, for I had no measure at that time.
However, this was a great encouragement to
me, and I foresaw that, in time, it would please God to supply me with bread.
And yet here I was perplexed again, for I neither knew how to grind or make
meal of my corn, or indeed how to clean it and part it; nor, if made into meal,
how to make bread of it; and if how to make it, yet I knew not how to bake it.
These things being added to my desire of having a good quantity for store, and
to secure a constant supply, I resolved not to taste any of this crop but to
preserve it all for seed against the next season; and in the meantime to employ
all my study and hours of working to accomplish this great work of providing
myself with corn and bread.
It might be truly said, that now I worked
for my bread. I believe few people have thought much upon the strange multitude
of little things necessary in the providing, producing, curing, dressing,
making, and finishing this one article of bread.
I, that was reduced to a mere state of
nature, found this to my daily discouragement; and was made more sensible of it
every hour, even after I had got the first handful of seed-corn, which, as I
have said, came up unexpectedly, and indeed to a surprise.
First, I had no plough to turn up the
earth—no spade or shovel to dig it. Well, this I conquered by making me a
wooden spade, as I observed before; but this did my work but in a wooden
manner; and though it cost me a great many days to make it, yet, for want of
iron, it not only wore out soon, but made my work the harder, and made it be
performed much worse. However, this I bore with, and was content to work it out
with patience, and bear with the badness of the performance. When the corn was
sown, I had no harrow, but was forced to go over it myself, and drag a great
heavy bough of a tree over it, to scratch it, as it may be called, rather than
rake or harrow it. When it was growing, and grown, I have observed already how
many things I wanted to fence it, secure it, mow or reap it, cure and carry it
home, thrash, part it from the chaff, and save it. Then I wanted a mill to
grind it, sieves to dress it, yeast and salt to make it into bread, and an oven
to bake it; but all these things I did without, as shall be observed; and yet
the corn was an inestimable comfort and advantage to me too. All this, as I
said, made everything laborious and tedious to me; but that there was no help
for. Neither was my time so much loss to me, because, as I had divided it, a
certain part of it was every day appointed to these works; and as I had
resolved to use none of the corn for bread till I had a greater quantity by me,
I had the next six months to apply myself wholly, by labour and invention, to
furnish myself with utensils proper for the performing all the operations
necessary for making the corn, when I had it, fit for my use.
3/1-a
Tuesday- RC (Robinson Crusoe)-Ch.8 of 20=
1q Will Robinson Crusoe taste his crop?
Answer= no
2q What did he do with the bread (6 things, all -ing words)?
Answer= "providing, producing,
curing, dressing, making and finishing"
3q What kind of spade did he use?
Answer= a "wooden" one he made.
4q What did he not have? (at least 2 things)
Answer= a "plough" nor a
"harrow" for "corn."- nor a corn "mill" nor
"sieves to dress it" nor "yeast and salt to make into
bread" nor "an oven to bake it."
5q What "comforted" him?
Answer= (1 thing) "the corn."
BQ How long did he "apply" himself "wholly"?
Answer= "the next 6
months"
3/2
CHAPTER IX.
A BOAT
But first I was to prepare more land, for
I had now seed enough to sow above an acre of ground. Before I did this, I had
a week’s work at least to make me a spade, which, when it was done, was but a
sorry one indeed, and very heavy, and required double labour to work with it.
However, I got through that, and sowed my seed in two large flat pieces of
ground, as near my house as I could find them to my mind, and fenced them in
with a good hedge, the stakes of which were all cut off that wood which I had set
before, and knew it would grow; so that, in a year’s time, I knew I should have
a quick or living hedge, that would want but little repair. This work did not
take me up less than three months, because a great part of that time was the
wet season, when I could not go abroad. Within-doors, that is when it rained
and I could not go out, I found employment in the following occupations—always
observing, that all the while I was at work I diverted myself with talking to
my parrot, and teaching him to speak; and I quickly taught him to know his own
name, and at last to speak it out pretty loud, “Poll,” which was the first word
I ever heard spoken in the island by any mouth but my own. This, therefore, was
not my work, but an assistance to my work; for now, as I said, I had a great
employment upon my hands, as follows: I had long studied to make, by some means
or other, some earthen vessels, which, indeed, I wanted sorely, but knew not
where to come at them. However, considering the heat of the climate, I did not
doubt but if I could find out any clay, I might make some pots that might,
being dried in the sun, be hard enough and strong enough to bear handling, and
to hold anything that was dry, and required to be kept so; and as this was
necessary in the preparing corn, meal, &c., which was the thing I was
doing, I resolved to make some as large as I could, and fit only to stand like
jars, to hold what should be put into them.
It would make the reader pity me, or
rather laugh at me, to tell how many awkward ways I took to raise this paste;
what odd, misshapen, ugly things I made; how many of them fell in and how many
fell out, the clay not being stiff enough to bear its own weight; how many
cracked by the over-violent heat of the sun, being set out too hastily; and how
many fell in pieces with only removing, as well before as after they were
dried; and, in a word, how, after having laboured hard to find the clay—to dig
it, to temper it, to bring it home, and work it—I could not make above two
large earthen ugly things (I cannot call them jars) in about two months’
labour.
However, as the sun baked these two very
dry and hard, I lifted them very gently up, and set them down again in two
great wicker baskets, which I had made on purpose for them, that they might not
break; and as between the pot and the basket there was a little room to spare,
I stuffed it full of the rice and barley straw; and these two pots being to
stand always dry I thought would hold my dry corn, and perhaps the meal, when
the corn was bruised.
Though I miscarried so much in my design
for large pots, yet I made several smaller things with better success; such as
little round pots, flat dishes, pitchers, and pipkins, and any things my hand
turned to; and the heat of the sun baked them quite hard.
But all this would not answer my end,
which was to get an earthen pot to hold what was liquid, and bear the fire,
which none of these could do. It happened after some time, making a pretty
large fire for cooking my meat, when I went to put it out after I had done with
it, I found a broken piece of one of my earthenware vessels in the fire, burnt
as hard as a stone, and red as a tile. I was agreeably surprised to see it, and
said to myself, that certainly they might be made to burn whole, if they would
burn broken.
This set me to study how to order my fire,
so as to make it burn some pots. I had no notion of a kiln, such as the potters
burn in, or of glazing them with lead, though I had some lead to do it with;
but I placed three large pipkins and two or three pots in a pile, one upon
another, and placed my firewood all round it, with a great heap of embers under
them. I plied the fire with fresh fuel round the outside and upon the top, till
I saw the pots in the inside red-hot quite through, and observed that they did
not crack at all. When I saw them clear red, I let them stand in that heat
about five or six hours, till I found one of them, though it did not crack, did
melt or run; for the sand which was mixed with the clay melted by the violence
of the heat, and would have run into glass if I had gone on; so I slacked my
fire gradually till the pots began to abate of the red colour; and watching
them all night, that I might not let the fire abate too fast, in the morning I
had three very good (I will not say handsome) pipkins, and two other earthen
pots, as hard burnt as could be desired, and one of them perfectly glazed with
the running of the sand.
After this experiment, I need not say that
I wanted no sort of earthenware for my use; but I must needs say as to the
shapes of them, they were very indifferent, as any one may suppose, when I had
no way of making them but as the children make dirt pies, or as a woman would
make pies that never learned to raise paste.
No joy at a thing of so mean a nature was
ever equal to mine, when I found I had made an earthen pot that would bear the
fire; and I had hardly patience to stay till they were cold before I set one on
the fire again with some water in it to boil me some meat, which it did
admirably well; and with a piece of a kid I made some very good broth, though I
wanted oatmeal, and several other ingredients requisite to make it as good as I
would have had it been.
My next concern was to get me a stone
mortar to stamp or beat some corn in; for as to the mill, there was no thought
of arriving at that perfection of art with one pair of hands. To supply this
want, I was at a great loss; for, of all the trades in the world, I was as
perfectly unqualified for a stone-cutter as for any whatever; neither had I any
tools to go about it with. I spent many a day to find out a great stone big
enough to cut hollow, and make fit for a mortar, and could find none at all,
except what was in the solid rock, and which I had no way to dig or cut out;
nor indeed were the rocks in the island of hardness sufficient, but were all of
a sandy, crumbling stone, which neither would bear the weight of a heavy
pestle, nor would break the corn without filling it with sand. So, after a
great deal of time lost in searching for a stone, I gave it over, and resolved
to look out for a great block of hard wood, which I found, indeed, much easier;
and getting one as big as I had strength to stir, I rounded it, and formed it
on the outside with my axe and hatchet, and then with the help of fire and
infinite labour, made a hollow place in it, as the Indians in Brazil make their
canoes. After this, I made a great heavy pestle or beater of the wood called
the iron-wood; and this I prepared and laid by against I had my next crop of
corn, which I proposed to myself to grind, or rather pound into meal to make
bread.
My next difficulty was to make a sieve or
searce, to dress my meal, and to part it from the bran and the husk; without
which I did not see it possible I could have any bread. This was a most
difficult thing even to think on, for to be sure I had nothing like the
necessary thing to make it—I mean fine thin canvas or stuff to searce the meal
through. And here I was at a full stop for many months; nor did I really know
what to do. Linen I had none left but what was mere rags; I had goat’s hair,
but neither knew how to weave it or spin it; and had I known how, here were no
tools to work it with. All the remedy that I found for this was, that at last I
did remember I had, among the seamen’s clothes which were saved out of the
ship, some neckcloths of calico or muslin; and with some pieces of these I made
three small sieves proper enough for the work; and thus I made shift for some
years: how I did afterwards, I shall show in its place.
The baking part was the next thing to be
considered, and how I should make bread when I came to have corn; for first, I
had no yeast. As to that part, there was no supplying the want, so I did not
concern myself much about it. But for an oven I was indeed in great pain. At
length I found out an experiment for that also, which was this: I made some
earthen-vessels very broad but not deep, that is to say, about two feet
diameter, and not above nine inches deep. These I burned in the fire, as I had
done the other, and laid them by; and when I wanted to bake, I made a great
fire upon my hearth, which I had paved with some square tiles of my own baking
and burning also; but I should not call them square.
When the firewood was burned pretty much
into embers or live coals, I drew them forward upon this hearth, so as to cover
it all over, and there I let them lie till the hearth was very hot. Then
sweeping away all the embers, I set down my loaf or loaves, and whelming down
the earthen pot upon them, drew the embers all round the outside of the pot, to
keep in and add to the heat; and thus as well as in the best oven in the world,
I baked my barley-loaves, and became in little time a good pastrycook into the
bargain; for I made myself several cakes and puddings of the rice; but I made
no pies, neither had I anything to put into them supposing I had, except the
flesh either of fowls or goats.
It need not be wondered at if all these
things took me up most part of the third year of my abode here; for it is to be
observed that in the intervals of these things I had my new harvest and
husbandry to manage; for I reaped my corn in its season, and carried it home as
well as I could, and laid it up in the ear, in my large baskets, till I had
time to rub it out, for I had no floor to thrash it on, or instrument to thrash
it with.
And now, indeed, my stock of corn
increasing, I really wanted to build my barns bigger; I wanted a place to lay
it up in, for the increase of the corn now yielded me so much, that I had of
the barley about twenty bushels, and of the rice as much or more; insomuch that
now I resolved to begin to use it freely; for my bread had been quite gone a
great while; also I resolved to see what quantity would be sufficient for me a
whole year, and to sow but once a year.
Upon the whole, I found that the forty
bushels of barley and rice were much more than I could consume in a year; so I
resolved to sow just the same quantity every year that I sowed the last, in
hopes that such a quantity would fully provide me with bread, &c.
All the while these things were doing, you
may be sure my thoughts ran many times upon the prospect of land which I had
seen from the other side of the island; and I was not without secret wishes
that I were on shore there, fancying that, seeing the mainland, and an inhabited
country, I might find some way or other to convey myself further, and perhaps
at last find some means of escape.
But all this while I made no allowance for
the dangers of such an undertaking, and how I might fall into the hands of
savages, and perhaps such as I might have reason to think far worse than the
lions and tigers of Africa: that if I once came in their power, I should run a
hazard of more than a thousand to one of being killed, and perhaps of being
eaten; for I had heard that the people of the Caribbean coast were cannibals or
man-eaters, and I knew by the latitude that I could not be far from that shore.
Then, supposing they were not cannibals, yet they might kill me, as many
Europeans who had fallen into their hands had been served, even when they had
been ten or twenty together—much more I, that was but one, and could make
little or no defence; all these things, I say, which I ought to have considered
well; and did come into my thoughts afterwards, yet gave me no apprehensions at
first, and my head ran mightily upon the thought of getting over to the shore.
Now I wished for my boy Xury, and the
long-boat with shoulder-of-mutton sail, with which I sailed above a thousand
miles on the coast of Africa; but this was in vain: then I thought I would go
and look at our ship’s boat, which, as I have said, was blown up upon the shore
a great way, in the storm, when we were first cast away. She lay almost where
she did at first, but not quite; and was turned, by the force of the waves and
the winds, almost bottom upward, against a high ridge of beachy, rough sand,
but no water about her. If I had had hands to have refitted her, and to have
launched her into the water, the boat would have done well enough, and I might
have gone back into the Brazils with her easily enough; but I might have
foreseen that I could no more turn her and set her upright upon her bottom than
I could remove the island; however, I went to the woods, and cut levers and
rollers, and brought them to the boat resolving to try what I could do;
suggesting to myself that if I could but turn her down, I might repair the
damage she had received, and she would be a very good boat, and I might go to
sea in her very easily.
I spared no pains, indeed, in this piece
of fruitless toil, and spent, I think, three or four weeks about it; at last
finding it impossible to heave it up with my little strength, I fell to digging
away the sand, to undermine it, and so to make it fall down, setting pieces of
wood to thrust and guide it right in the fall.
But when I had done this, I was unable to
stir it up again, or to get under it, much less to move it forward towards the
water; so I was forced to give it over; and yet, though I gave over the hopes
of the boat, my desire to venture over for the main increased, rather than
decreased, as the means for it seemed impossible.
This at length put me upon thinking
whether it was not possible to make myself a canoe, or periagua, such as the
natives of those climates make, even without tools, or, as I might say, without
hands, of the trunk of a great tree. This I not only thought possible, but
easy, and pleased myself extremely with the thoughts of making it, and with my
having much more convenience for it than any of the negroes or Indians; but not
at all considering the particular inconveniences which I lay under more than
the Indians did—viz. want of hands to move it, when it was made, into the
water—a difficulty much harder for me to surmount than all the consequences of
want of tools could be to them; for what was it to me, if when I had chosen a
vast tree in the woods, and with much trouble cut it down, if I had been able
with my tools to hew and dub the outside into the proper shape of a boat, and
burn or cut out the inside to make it hollow, so as to make a boat of it—if,
after all this, I must leave it just there where I found it, and not be able to
launch it into the water?
One would have thought I could not have
had the least reflection upon my mind of my circumstances while I was making
this boat, but I should have immediately thought how I should get it into the
sea; but my thoughts were so intent upon my voyage over the sea in it, that I
never once considered how I should get it off the land: and it was really, in
its own nature, more easy for me to guide it over forty-five miles of sea than
about forty-five fathoms of land, where it lay, to set it afloat in the water.
I went to work upon this boat the most
like a fool that ever man did who had any of his senses awake. I pleased myself
with the design, without determining whether I was ever able to undertake it;
not but that the difficulty of launching my boat came often into my head; but I
put a stop to my inquiries into it by this foolish answer which I gave
myself—“Let me first make it; I warrant I will find some way or other to get it
along when it is done.”
3/2- a Wednesday-RC
-Ch. 9, 1st half, of 20=
1q What kind of "sail" did he wish for?
Answer= "shoulder of
mutton"
2q What blew his "ship's boat" "upon the shore a great way"?
Answer="the storm."
3q What "coast" was he sailing on?
Answer= "the coast of Africa."
4q What kind of "tree"? (1 adjective)
Answer= "vast" (huge)
5q What is a "periagua"?
Answer= Robinson Crusoe says it's "a canoe" as
"agua" in Spanish for "water" so "something in
water" (Google Translate was helpful)
BQ What was "a difficulty much harder for me to surmount than all the consequences of want of tools could be to them" ?
Answer= "when it was made,(put) into the
water."
3/3
This
was a most preposterous method; but the eagerness of my fancy prevailed, and to
work I went. I felled a cedar-tree, and I question much whether Solomon ever
had such a one for the building of the Temple of Jerusalem; it was five feet
ten inches diameter at the lower part next the stump, and four feet eleven
inches diameter at the end of
twenty-two feet; after which it lessened for a while, and then parted into
branches. It was not without infinite labour that I felled this tree; I was
twenty days hacking and hewing at it at the bottom; I was fourteen more getting
the branches and limbs and the vast spreading head cut off, which I hacked and
hewed through with axe and hatchet, and inexpressible labour; after this, it
cost me a month to shape it and dub it to a proportion, and to something like
the bottom of a boat, that it might swim upright as it ought to do. It cost me
near three months more to clear the inside, and work it out so as to make an
exact boat of it; this I did, indeed, without fire, by mere mallet and chisel,
and by the dint of hard labour, till I had brought it to be a very handsome
periagua, and big enough to have carried six-and-twenty men, and consequently big
enough to have carried me and all my cargo.
When I had gone through this work I was
extremely delighted with it. The boat was really much bigger than ever I saw a
canoe or periagua, that was made of one tree, in my life. Many a weary stroke
it had cost, you may be sure; and had I gotten it into the water, I make no
question, but I should have begun the maddest voyage, and the most unlikely to
be performed, that ever was undertaken.
But all my devices to get it into the
water failed me; though they cost me infinite labour too. It lay about one
hundred yards from the water, and not more; but the first inconvenience was, it
was up hill towards the creek. Well, to take away this discouragement, I
resolved to dig into the surface of the earth, and so make a declivity: this I
began, and it cost me a prodigious deal of pains (but who grudge pains who have
their deliverance in view?); but when this was worked through, and this
difficulty managed, it was still much the same, for I could no more stir the
canoe than I could the other boat. Then I measured the distance of ground, and
resolved to cut a dock or canal, to bring the water up to the canoe, seeing I
could not bring the canoe down to the water. Well, I began this work; and when
I began to enter upon it, and calculate how deep it was to be dug, how broad,
how the stuff was to be thrown out, I found that, by the number of hands I had,
being none but my own, it must have been ten or twelve years before I could
have gone through with it; for the shore lay so high, that at the upper end it
must have been at least twenty feet deep; so at length, though with great
reluctancy, I gave this attempt over also.
This grieved me heartily; and now I saw,
though too late, the folly of beginning a work before we count the cost, and
before we judge rightly of our own strength to go through with it.
In the middle of this work I finished my
fourth year in this place, and kept my anniversary with the same devotion, and
with as much comfort as ever before; for, by a constant study and serious
application to the Word of God, and by the assistance of His grace, I gained a
different knowledge from what I had before. I entertained different notions of
things. I looked now upon the world as a thing remote, which I had nothing to
do with, no expectations from, and, indeed, no desires about: in a word, I had
nothing indeed to do with it, nor was ever likely to have, so I thought it
looked, as we may perhaps look upon it hereafter—viz. as a place I had lived
in, but was come out of it; and well might I say, as Father Abraham to Dives,
“Between me and thee is a great gulf fixed.”
In the first place, I was removed from all
the wickedness of the world here; I had neither the lusts of the flesh, the
lusts of the eye, nor the pride of life. I had nothing to covet, for I had all
that I was now capable of enjoying; I was lord of the whole manor; or, if I
pleased, I might call myself king or emperor over the whole country which I had
possession of: there were no rivals; I had no competitor, none to dispute
sovereignty or command with me: I might have raised ship-loadings of corn, but
I had no use for it; so I let as little grow as I thought enough for my
occasion. I had tortoise or turtle enough, but now and then one was as much as
I could put to any use: I had timber enough to have built a fleet of ships; and
I had grapes enough to have made wine, or to have cured into raisins, to have
loaded that fleet when it had been built.
But all I could make use of was all that
was valuable: I had enough to eat and supply my wants, and what was all the
rest to me? If I killed more flesh than I could eat, the dog must eat it, or
vermin; if I sowed more corn than I could eat, it must be spoiled; the trees
that I cut down were lying to rot on the ground; I could make no more use of
them but for fuel, and that I had no occasion for but to dress my food.
In a word, the nature and experience of
things dictated to me, upon just reflection, that all the good things of this
world are no farther good to us than they are for our use; and that, whatever
we may heap up to give others, we enjoy just as much as we can use, and no
more. The most covetous, griping miser in the world would have been cured of
the vice of covetousness if he had been in my case; for I possessed infinitely
more than I knew what to do with. I had no room for desire, except it was of
things which I had not, and they were but trifles, though, indeed, of great use
to me. I had, as I hinted before, a parcel of money, as well gold as silver,
about thirty-six pounds sterling. Alas! there the sorry, useless stuff lay; I
had no more manner of business for it; and often thought with myself that I
would have given a handful of it for a gross of tobacco-pipes; or for a
hand-mill to grind my corn; nay, I would have given it all for a sixpenny-worth
of turnip and carrot seed out of England, or for a handful of peas and beans,
and a bottle of ink. As it was, I had not the least advantage by it or benefit
from it; but there it lay in a drawer, and grew mouldy with the damp of the
cave in the wet seasons; and if I had had the drawer full of diamonds, it had
been the same case—they had been of no manner of value to me, because of no
use.
I had now brought my state of life to be
much easier in itself than it was at first, and much easier to my mind, as well
as to my body. I frequently sat down to meat with thankfulness, and admired the
hand of God’s providence, which had thus spread my table in the wilderness. I
learned to look more upon the bright side of my condition, and less upon the
dark side, and to consider what I enjoyed rather than what I wanted; and this
gave me sometimes such secret comforts, that I cannot express them; and which I
take notice of here, to put those discontented people in mind of it, who cannot
enjoy comfortably what God has given them, because they see and covet something
that He has not given them. All our discontents about what we want appeared to
me to spring from the want of thankfulness for what we have.
Another reflection was of great use to me,
and doubtless would be so to any one that should fall into such distress as
mine was; and this was, to compare my present condition with what I at first
expected it would be; nay, with what it would certainly have been, if the good
providence of God had not wonderfully ordered the ship to be cast up nearer to
the shore, where I not only could come at her, but could bring what I got out
of her to the shore, for my relief and comfort; without which, I had wanted for
tools to work, weapons for defence, and gunpowder and shot for getting my food.
I spent whole hours, I may say whole days,
in representing to myself, in the most lively colours, how I must have acted if
I had got nothing out of the ship. How I could not have so much as got any
food, except fish and turtles; and that, as it was long before I found any of
them, I must have perished first; that I should have lived, if I had not
perished, like a mere savage; that if I had killed a goat or a fowl, by any
contrivance, I had no way to flay or open it, or part the flesh from the skin
and the bowels, or to cut it up; but must gnaw it with my teeth, and pull it
with my claws, like a beast.
These reflections made me very sensible of
the goodness of Providence to me, and very thankful for my present condition, with
all its hardships and misfortunes; and this part also I cannot but recommend to
the reflection of those who are apt, in their misery, to say, “Is any
affliction like mine?” Let them consider how much worse the cases of some
people are, and their case might have been, if Providence had thought fit.
I had another reflection, which assisted
me also to comfort my mind with hopes; and this was comparing my present
situation with what I had deserved, and had therefore reason to expect from the
hand of Providence. I had lived a dreadful life, perfectly destitute of the
knowledge and fear of God. I had been well instructed by father and mother;
neither had they been wanting to me in their early endeavours to infuse a
religious awe of God into my mind, a sense of my duty, and what the nature and
end of my being required of me. But, alas! falling early into the seafaring
life, which of all lives is the most destitute of the fear of God, though His
terrors are always before them; I say, falling early into the seafaring life,
and into seafaring company, all that little sense of religion which I had
entertained was laughed out of me by my messmates; by a hardened despising of
dangers, and the views of death, which grew habitual to me by my long absence
from all manner of opportunities to converse with anything but what was like
myself, or to hear anything that was good or tended towards it.
So void was I of everything that was good,
or the least sense of what I was, or was to be, that, in the greatest
deliverances I enjoyed—such as my escape from Sallee; my being taken up by the
Portuguese master of the ship; my being planted so well in the Brazils; my
receiving the cargo from England, and the like—I never had once the words
“Thank God!” so much as on my mind, or in my mouth; nor in the greatest
distress had I so much as a thought to pray to Him, or so much as to say,
“Lord, have mercy upon me!” no, nor to mention the name of God, unless it was
to swear by, and blaspheme it.
I had terrible reflections upon my mind
for many months, as I have already observed, on account of my wicked and
hardened life past; and when I looked about me, and considered what particular
providences had attended me since my coming into this place, and how God had
dealt bountifully with me—had not only punished me less than my iniquity had
deserved, but had so plentifully provided for me—this gave me great hopes that
my repentance was accepted, and that God had yet mercy in store for me.
With these reflections I worked my mind
up, not only to a resignation to the will of God in the present disposition of
my circumstances, but even to a sincere thankfulness for my condition; and that
I, who was yet a living man, ought not to complain, seeing I had not the due
punishment of my sins; that I enjoyed so many mercies which I had no reason to
have expected in that place; that I ought never more to repine at my condition,
but to rejoice, and to give daily thanks for that daily bread, which nothing
but a crowd of wonders could have brought; that I ought to consider I had been
fed even by a miracle, even as great as that of feeding Elijah by ravens, nay,
by a long series of miracles; and that I could hardly have named a place in the
uninhabitable part of the world where I could have been cast more to my advantage;
a place where, as I had no society, which was my affliction on one hand, so I
found no ravenous beasts, no furious wolves or tigers, to threaten my life; no
venomous creatures, or poisons, which I might feed on to my hurt; no savages to
murder and devour me. In a word, as my life was a life of sorrow one way, so it
was a life of mercy another; and I wanted nothing to make it a life of comfort
but to be able to make my sense of God’s goodness to me, and care over me in
this condition, be my daily consolation; and after I did make a just
improvement on these things, I went away, and was no more sad. I had now been
here so long that many things which I had brought on shore for my help were
either quite gone, or very much wasted and near spent.
My ink, as I observed, had been gone some
time, all but a very little, which I eked out with water, a little and a
little, till it was so pale, it scarce left any appearance of black upon the
paper. As long as it lasted I made use of it to minute down the days of the month
on which any remarkable thing happened to me; and first, by casting up times
past, I remembered that there was a strange concurrence of days in the various
providences which befell me, and which, if I had been superstitiously inclined
to observe days as fatal or fortunate, I might have had reason to have looked
upon with a great deal of curiosity.
First, I had observed that the same day
that I broke away from my father and friends and ran away to Hull, in order to
go to sea, the same day afterwards I was taken by the Sallee man-of-war, and
made a slave; the same day of the year that I escaped out of the wreck of that
ship in Yarmouth Roads, that same day-year afterwards I made my escape from
Sallee in a boat; the same day of the year I was born on—viz. the 30th of
September, that same day I had my life so miraculously saved twenty-six years
after, when I was cast on shore in this island; so that my wicked life and my
solitary life began both on a day.
The next thing to my ink being wasted was
that of my bread—I mean the biscuit which I brought out of the ship; this I had
husbanded to the last degree, allowing myself but one cake of bread a-day for
above a year; and yet I was quite without bread for near a year before I got
any corn of my own, and great reason I had to be thankful that I had any at
all, the getting it being, as has been already observed, next to miraculous.
My clothes, too, began to decay; as to
linen, I had had none a good while, except some chequered shirts which I found
in the chests of the other seamen, and which I carefully preserved; because
many times I could bear no other clothes on but a shirt; and it was a very
great help to me that I had, among all the men’s clothes of the ship, almost
three dozen of shirts. There were also, indeed, several thick watch-coats of
the seamen’s which were left, but they were too hot to wear; and though it is
true that the weather was so violently hot that there was no need of clothes,
yet I could not go quite naked—no, though I had been inclined to it, which I
was not—nor could I abide the thought of it, though I was alone. The reason why
I could not go naked was, I could not bear the heat of the sun so well when
quite naked as with some clothes on; nay, the very heat frequently blistered my
skin: whereas, with a shirt on, the air itself made some motion, and whistling
under the shirt, was twofold cooler than without it. No more could I ever bring
myself to go out in the heat of the sun without a cap or a hat; the heat of the
sun, beating with such violence as it does in that place, would give me the
headache presently, by darting so directly on my head, without a cap or hat on,
so that I could not bear it; whereas, if I put on my hat it would presently go
away.
Upon these views I began to consider about
putting the few rags I had, which I called clothes, into some order; I had worn
out all the waistcoats I had, and my business was now to try if I could not
make jackets out of the great watch-coats which I had by me, and with such
other materials as I had; so I set to work, tailoring, or rather, indeed,
botching, for I made most piteous work of it. However, I made shift to make two
or three new waistcoats, which I hoped would serve me a great while: as for
breeches or drawers, I made but a very sorry shift indeed till afterwards.
I have mentioned that I saved the skins of
all the creatures that I killed, I mean four-footed ones, and I had them hung
up, stretched out with sticks in the sun, by which means some of them were so
dry and hard that they were fit for little, but others were very useful. The
first thing I made of these was a great cap for my head, with the hair on the
outside, to shoot off the rain; and this I performed so well, that after I made
me a suit of clothes wholly of these skins—that is to say, a waistcoat, and
breeches open at the knees, and both loose, for they were rather wanting to
keep me cool than to keep me warm. I must not omit to acknowledge that they
were wretchedly made; for if I was a bad carpenter, I was a worse tailor.
However, they were such as I made very good shift with, and when I was out, if
it happened to rain, the hair of my waistcoat and cap being outermost, I was
kept very dry.
After this, I spent a great deal of time
and pains to make an umbrella; I was, indeed, in great want of one, and had a
great mind to make one; I had seen them made in the Brazils, where they are
very useful in the great heats there, and I felt the heats every jot as great
here, and greater too, being nearer the equinox; besides, as I was obliged to
be much abroad, it was a most useful thing to me, as well for the rains as the
heats. I took a world of pains with it, and was a great while before I could
make anything likely to hold: nay, after I had thought I had hit the way, I
spoiled two or three before I made one to my mind: but at last I made one that
answered indifferently well: the main difficulty I found was to make it let
down. I could make it spread, but if it did not let down too, and draw in, it
was not portable for me any way but just over my head, which would not do.
However, at last, as I said, I made one to answer, and covered it with skins,
the hair upwards, so that it cast off the rain like a pent-house, and kept off
the sun so effectually, that I could walk out in the hottest of the weather
with greater advantage than I could before in the coolest, and when I had no
need of it could close it, and carry it under my arm.
Thus I lived mighty comfortably, my mind
being entirely composed by resigning myself to the will of God, and throwing myself
wholly upon the disposal of His providence. This made my life better than
sociable, for when I began to regret the want of conversation I would ask
myself, whether thus conversing mutually with my own thoughts, and (as I hope I
may say) with even God Himself, by ejaculations, was not better than the utmost
enjoyment of human society in the world?
3/3-a Thursday-RC-Ch. 9, 2nd half,
of 20=
1q What was Robinson Crusoe's boy's name?
Answer= "Xury" (like "luxury")
2q What of Robinson Crusoe's "began to decay"?
Answer= his "clothes."
3q What was "too hot to wear"?
Answer= "several thick watch coats" / "warm
overcoats worn by sailors in cold or stormy weather." (MW.com)
4q What "would give" him a "headache"?
Answer= "the heat of the sun."
5q His "few rags" are?
Answer= "clothes."
BQ What did Robinson Crusoe make?
Answer= "an umbrella...very useful in the heats there." a sun
umbrella/a parasol.
3/4
CHAPTER X.
TAMES GOATS
I cannot say that after this, for five
years, any extraordinary thing happened to me, but I lived on in the same
course, in the same posture and place, as before; the chief things I was
employed in, besides my yearly labour of planting my barley and rice, and
curing my raisins, of both which I always kept up just enough to have
sufficient stock of one year’s provisions beforehand; I say, besides this
yearly labour, and my daily pursuit of going out with my gun, I had one labour,
to make a canoe, which at last I finished: so that, by digging a canal to it of
six feet wide and four feet deep, I brought it into the creek, almost half a
mile. As for the first, which was so vastly big, for I made it without
considering beforehand, as I ought to have done, how I should be able to launch
it, so, never being able to bring it into the water, or bring the water to it,
I was obliged to let it lie where it was as a memorandum to teach me to be
wiser the next time: indeed, the next time, though I could not get a tree proper
for it, and was in a place where I could not get the water to it at any less
distance than, as I have said, near half a mile, yet, as I saw it was
practicable at last, I never gave it over; and though I was near two years
about it, yet I never grudged my labour, in hopes of having a boat to go off to
sea at last.
However, though my little periagua was
finished, yet the size of it was not at all answerable to the design which I
had in view when I made the first; I mean of venturing over to the terra
firma, where it was above forty miles broad; accordingly, the smallness of
my boat assisted to put an end to that design, and now I thought no more of it.
As I had a boat, my next design was to make a cruise round the island; for as I
had been on the other side in one place, crossing, as I have already described
it, over the land, so the discoveries I made in that little journey made me
very eager to see other parts of the coast; and now I had a boat, I thought of
nothing but sailing round the island.
For this purpose, that I might do
everything with discretion and consideration, I fitted up a little mast in my
boat, and made a sail too out of some of the pieces of the ship’s sails which
lay in store, and of which I had a great stock by me. Having fitted my mast and
sail, and tried the boat, I found she would sail very well; then I made little
lockers or boxes at each end of my boat, to put provisions, necessaries,
ammunition, &c., into, to be kept dry, either from rain or the spray of the
sea; and a little, long, hollow place I cut in the inside of the boat, where I
could lay my gun, making a flap to hang down over it to keep it dry.
I fixed my umbrella also in the step at
the stern, like a mast, to stand over my head, and keep the heat of the sun off
me, like an awning; and thus I every now and then took a little voyage upon the
sea, but never went far out, nor far from the little creek. At last, being
eager to view the circumference of my little kingdom, I resolved upon my
cruise; and accordingly I victualled my ship for the voyage, putting in two
dozen of loaves (cakes I should call them) of barley-bread, an earthen pot full
of parched rice (a food I ate a good deal of), a little bottle of rum, half a
goat, and powder and shot for killing more, and two large watch-coats, of those
which, as I mentioned before, I had saved out of the seamen’s chests; these I
took, one to lie upon, and the other to cover me in the night.
It was the 6th of November, in the sixth
year of my reign—or my captivity, which you please—that I set out on this
voyage, and I found it much longer than I expected; for though the island
itself was not very large, yet when I came to the east side of it, I found a
great ledge of rocks lie out about two leagues into the sea, some above water,
some under it; and beyond that a shoal of sand, lying dry half a league more,
so that I was obliged to go a great way out to sea to double the point.
When I first discovered them, I was going
to give over my enterprise, and come back again, not knowing how far it might
oblige me to go out to sea; and above all, doubting how I should get back
again: so I came to an anchor; for I had made a kind of an anchor with a piece
of a broken grappling which I got out of the ship.
Having secured my boat, I took my gun and
went on shore, climbing up a hill, which seemed to overlook that point where I
saw the full extent of it, and resolved to venture.
In my viewing the sea from that hill where
I stood, I perceived a strong, and indeed a most furious current, which ran to
the east, and even came close to the point; and I took the more notice of it
because I saw there might be some danger that when I came into it I might be
carried out to sea by the strength of it, and not be able to make the island
again; and indeed, had I not got first upon this hill, I believe it would have
been so; for there was the same current on the other side the island, only that
it set off at a further distance, and I saw there was a strong eddy under the
shore; so I had nothing to do but to get out of the first current, and I should
presently be in an eddy.
I lay here, however, two days, because the
wind blowing pretty fresh at ESE., and that being just contrary to the current,
made a great breach of the sea upon the point: so that it was not safe for me to
keep too close to the shore for the breach, nor to go too far off, because of
the stream.
The third day, in the morning, the wind
having abated overnight, the sea was calm, and I ventured: but I am a warning
to all rash and ignorant pilots; for no sooner was I come to the point, when I
was not even my boat’s length from the shore, but I found myself in a great
depth of water, and a current like the sluice of a mill; it carried my boat
along with it with such violence that all I could do could not keep her so much
as on the edge of it; but I found it hurried me farther and farther out from
the eddy, which was on my left hand. There was no wind stirring to help me, and
all I could do with my paddles signified nothing: and now I began to give
myself over for lost; for as the current was on both sides of the island, I
knew in a few leagues distance they must join again, and then I was
irrecoverably gone; nor did I see any possibility of avoiding it; so that I had
no prospect before me but of perishing, not by the sea, for that was calm
enough, but of starving from hunger. I had, indeed, found a tortoise on the
shore, as big almost as I could lift, and had tossed it into the boat; and I
had a great jar of fresh water, that is to say, one of my earthen pots; but what
was all this to being driven into the vast ocean, where, to be sure, there was
no shore, no mainland or island, for a thousand leagues at least?
And now I saw how easy it was for the
providence of God to make even the most miserable condition of mankind worse.
Now I looked back upon my desolate, solitary island as the most pleasant place
in the world and all the happiness my heart could wish for was to be but there
again. I stretched out my hands to it, with eager wishes—“O happy desert!” said
I, “I shall never see thee more. O miserable creature! whither am going?” Then
I reproached myself with my unthankful temper, and that I had repined at my
solitary condition; and now what would I give to be on shore there again! Thus,
we never see the true state of our condition till it is illustrated to us by
its contraries, nor know how to value what we enjoy, but by the want of it. It
is scarcely possible to imagine the consternation I was now in, being driven
from my beloved island (for so it appeared to me now to be) into the wide
ocean, almost two leagues, and in the utmost despair of ever recovering it
again. However, I worked hard till, indeed, my strength was almost exhausted,
and kept my boat as much to the northward, that is, towards the side of the
current which the eddy lay on, as possibly I could; when about noon, as the sun
passed the meridian, I thought I felt a little breeze of wind in my face,
springing up from SSE. This cheered my heart a little, and especially when, in
about half-an-hour more, it blew a pretty gentle gale. By this time I had got
at a frightful distance from the island, and had the least cloudy or hazy
weather intervened, I had been undone another way, too; for I had no compass on
board, and should never have known how to have steered towards the island, if I
had but once lost sight of it; but the weather continuing clear, I applied
myself to get up my mast again, and spread my sail, standing away to the north
as much as possible, to get out of the current.
Just as I had set my mast and sail, and
the boat began to stretch away, I saw even by the clearness of the water some
alteration of the current was near; for where the current was so strong the
water was foul; but perceiving the water clear, I found the current abate; and
presently I found to the east, at about half a mile, a breach of the sea upon
some rocks: these rocks I found caused the current to part again, and as the
main stress of it ran away more southerly, leaving the rocks to the north-east,
so the other returned by the repulse of the rocks, and made a strong eddy,
which ran back again to the north-west, with a very sharp stream.
They who know what it is to have a
reprieve brought to them upon the ladder, or to be rescued from thieves just
going to murder them, or who have been in such extremities, may guess what my
present surprise of joy was, and how gladly I put my boat into the stream of
this eddy; and the wind also freshening, how gladly I spread my sail to it,
running cheerfully before the wind, and with a strong tide or eddy underfoot.
This eddy carried me about a league on my
way back again, directly towards the island, but about two leagues more to the
northward than the current which carried me away at first; so that when I came
near the island, I found myself open to the northern shore of it, that is to
say, the other end of the island, opposite to that which I went out from.
When I had made something more than a
league of way by the help of this current or eddy, I found it was spent, and
served me no further. However, I found that being between two great
currents—viz. that on the south side, which had hurried me away, and that on
the north, which lay about a league on the other side; I say, between these
two, in the wake of the island, I found the water at least still, and running
no way; and having still a breeze of wind fair for me, I kept on steering
directly for the island, though not making such fresh way as I did before.
About four o’clock in the evening, being
then within a league of the island, I found the point of the rocks which
occasioned this disaster stretching out, as is described before, to the
southward, and casting off the current more southerly, had, of course, made
another eddy to the north; and this I found very strong, but not directly
setting the way my course lay, which was due west, but almost full north.
However, having a fresh gale, I stretched across this eddy, slanting
north-west; and in about an hour came within about a mile of the shore, where,
it being smooth water, I soon got to land.
When I was on shore, God I fell on my
knees and gave God thanks for my deliverance, resolving to lay aside all
thoughts of my deliverance by my boat; and refreshing myself with such things
as I had, I brought my boat close to the shore, in a little cove that I had
spied under some trees, and laid me down to sleep, being quite spent with the
labour and fatigue of the voyage.
I was now at a great loss which way to get
home with my boat! I had run so much hazard, and knew too much of the case, to
think of attempting it by the way I went out; and what might be at the other
side (I mean the west side) I knew not, nor had I any mind to run any more
ventures; so I resolved on the next morning to make my way westward along the
shore, and to see if there was no creek where I might lay up my frigate in
safety, so as to have her again if I wanted her. In about three miles or
thereabouts, coasting the shore, I came to a very good inlet or bay, about a
mile over, which narrowed till it came to a very little rivulet or brook, where
I found a very convenient harbour for my boat, and where she lay as if she had
been in a little dock made on purpose for her. Here I put in, and having stowed
my boat very safe, I went on shore to look about me, and see where I was.
I soon found I had but a little passed by
the place where I had been before, when I travelled on foot to that shore; so
taking nothing out of my boat but my gun and umbrella, for it was exceedingly
hot, I began my march. The way was comfortable enough after such a voyage as I
had been upon, and I reached my old bower in the evening, where I found
everything standing as I left it; for I always kept it in good order, being, as
I said before, my country house.
I got over the fence, and laid me down in
the shade to rest my limbs, for I was very weary, and fell asleep; but judge
you, if you can, that read my story, what a surprise I must be in when I was
awaked out of my sleep by a voice calling me by my name several times, “Robin,
Robin, Robin Crusoe: poor Robin Crusoe! Where are you, Robin Crusoe? Where are
you? Where have you been?”
I was so dead asleep at first, being
fatigued with rowing, or part of the day, and with walking the latter part,
that I did not wake thoroughly; but dozing thought I dreamed that somebody
spoke to me; but as the voice continued to repeat, “Robin Crusoe, Robin
Crusoe,” at last I began to wake more perfectly, and was at first dreadfully
frightened, and started up in the utmost consternation; but no sooner were my
eyes open, but I saw my Poll sitting on the top of the hedge; and immediately
knew that it was he that spoke to me; for just in such bemoaning language I had
used to talk to him and teach him; and he had learned it so perfectly that he
would sit upon my finger, and lay his bill close to my face and cry, “Poor
Robin Crusoe! Where are you? Where have you been? How came you here?” and such
things as I had taught him.
However, even though I knew it was the
parrot, and that indeed it could be nobody else, it was a good while before I
could compose myself. First, I was amazed how the creature got thither; and
then, how he should just keep about the place, and nowhere else; but as I was
well satisfied it could be nobody but honest Poll, I got over it; and holding
out my hand, and calling him by his name, “Poll,” the sociable creature came to
me, and sat upon my thumb, as he used to do, and continued talking to me, “Poor
Robin Crusoe! and how did I come here? and where had I been?” just as if he had
been overjoyed to see me again; and so I carried him home along with me.
I had now had enough of rambling to sea
for some time, and had enough to do for many days to sit still and reflect upon
the danger I had been in. I would have been very glad to have had my boat again
on my side of the island; but I knew not how it was practicable to get it
about. As to the east side of the island, which I had gone round, I knew well
enough there was no venturing that way; my very heart would shrink, and my very
blood run chill, but to think of it; and as to the other side of the island, I
did not know how it might be there; but supposing the current ran with the same
force against the shore at the east as it passed by it on the other, I might
run the same risk of being driven down the stream, and carried by the island, as
I had been before of being carried away from it: so with these thoughts, I
contented myself to be without any boat, though it had been the product of so
many months’ labour to make it, and of so many more to get it into the sea.
In this government of my temper I remained
near a year; and lived a very sedate, retired life, as you may well suppose;
and my thoughts being very much composed as to my condition, and fully
comforted in resigning myself to the dispositions of Providence, I thought I
lived really very happily in all things except that of society.
I improved myself in this time in all the
mechanic exercises which my necessities put me upon applying myself to; and I
believe I should, upon occasion, have made a very good carpenter, especially
considering how few tools I had.
Besides this, I arrived at an unexpected
perfection in my earthenware, and contrived well enough to make them with a
wheel, which I found infinitely easier and better; because I made things round
and shaped, which before were filthy things indeed to look on. But I think I
was never more vain of my own performance, or more joyful for anything I found
out, than for my being able to make a tobacco-pipe; and though it was a very
ugly, clumsy thing when it was done, and only burned red, like other
earthenware, yet as it was hard and firm, and would draw the smoke, I was
exceedingly comforted with it, for I had been always used to smoke; and there
were pipes in the ship, but I forgot them at first, not thinking there was
tobacco in the island; and afterwards, when I searched the ship again, I could
not come at any pipes.
In my wicker-ware also I improved much,
and made abundance of necessary baskets, as well as my invention showed me;
though not very handsome, yet they were such as were very handy and convenient
for laying things up in, or fetching things home. For example, if I killed a
goat abroad, I could hang it up in a tree, flay it, dress it, and cut it in
pieces, and bring it home in a basket; and the like by a turtle; I could cut it
up, take out the eggs and a piece or two of the flesh, which was enough for me,
and bring them home in a basket, and leave the rest behind me. Also, large deep
baskets were the receivers of my corn, which I always rubbed out as soon as it
was dry and cured, and kept it in great baskets.
I began now to perceive my powder abated
considerably; this was a want which it was impossible for me to supply, and I
began seriously to consider what I must do when I should have no more powder;
that is to say, how I should kill any goats. I had, as is observed in the third
year of my being here, kept a young kid, and bred her up tame, and I was in
hopes of getting a he-goat; but I could not by any means bring it to pass, till
my kid grew an old goat; and as I could never find in my heart to kill her, she
died at last of mere age.
But being now in the eleventh year of my
residence, and, as I have said, my ammunition growing low, I set myself to
study some art to trap and snare the goats, to see whether I could not catch
some of them alive; and particularly I wanted a she-goat great with young. For
this purpose I made snares to hamper them; and I do believe they were more than
once taken in them; but my tackle was not good, for I had no wire, and I always
found them broken and my bait devoured. At length I resolved to try a pitfall;
so I dug several large pits in the earth, in places where I had observed the
goats used to feed, and over those pits I placed hurdles of my own making too,
with a great weight upon them; and several times I put ears of barley and dry
rice without setting the trap; and I could easily perceive that the goats had
gone in and eaten up the corn, for I could see the marks of their feet. At
length I set three traps in one night, and going the next morning I found them,
all standing, and yet the bait eaten and gone; this was very discouraging.
However, I altered my traps; and not to trouble you with particulars, going one
morning to see my traps, I found in one of them a large old he-goat; and in one
of the others three kids, a male and two females.
As to the old one, I knew not what to do
with him; he was so fierce I durst not go into the pit to him; that is to say,
to bring him away alive, which was what I wanted. I could have killed him, but
that was not my business, nor would it answer my end; so I even let him out,
and he ran away as if he had been frightened out of his wits. But I did not
then know what I afterwards learned, that hunger will tame a lion. If I had let
him stay three or four days without food, and then have carried him some water
to drink and then a little corn, he would have been as tame as one of the kids;
for they are mighty sagacious, tractable creatures, where they are well used.
However, for the present I let him go,
knowing no better at that time: then I went to the three kids, and taking them
one by one, I tied them with strings together, and with some difficulty brought
them all home.
It was a good while before they would
feed; but throwing them some sweet corn, it tempted them, and they began to be
tame. And now I found that if I expected to supply myself with goats’ flesh,
when I had no powder or shot left, breeding some up tame was my only way, when,
perhaps, I might have them about my house like a flock of sheep. But then it
occurred to me that I must keep the tame from the wild, or else they would
always run wild when they grew up; and the only way for this was to have some
enclosed piece of ground, well fenced either with hedge or pale, to keep them
in so effectually, that those within might not break out, or those without
break in.
This was a great undertaking for one pair
of hands yet, as I saw there was an absolute necessity for doing it, my first
work was to find out a proper piece of ground, where there was likely to be
herbage for them to eat, water for them to drink, and cover to keep them from
the sun.
Those who understand such enclosures will
think I had very little contrivance when I pitched upon a place very proper for
all these (being a plain, open piece of meadow land, or savannah, as our people
call it in the western colonies), which had two or three little drills of fresh
water in it, and at one end was very woody—I say, they will smile at my
forecast, when I shall tell them I began by enclosing this piece of ground in
such a manner that, my hedge or pale must have been at least two miles about.
Nor was the madness of it so great as to the compass, for if it was ten miles
about, I was like to have time enough to do it in; but I did not consider that
my goats would be as wild in so much compass as if they had had the whole
island, and I should have so much room to chase them in that I should never
catch them.
My hedge was begun and carried on, I
believe, about fifty yards when this thought occurred to me; so I presently stopped
short, and, for the beginning, I resolved to enclose a piece of about one
hundred and fifty yards in length, and one hundred yards in breadth, which, as
it would maintain as many as I should have in any reasonable time, so, as my
stock increased, I could add more ground to my enclosure.
This was acting with some prudence, and I
went to work with courage. I was about three months hedging in the first piece;
and, till I had done it, I tethered the three kids in the best part of it, and
used them to feed as near me as possible, to make them familiar; and very often
I would go and carry them some ears of barley, or a handful of rice, and feed
them out of my hand; so that after my enclosure was finished and I let them
loose, they would follow me up and down, bleating after me for a handful of
corn.
This answered my end, and in about a year
and a half I had a flock of about twelve goats, kids and all; and in two years
more I had three-and-forty, besides several that I took and killed for my food.
After that, I enclosed five several pieces of ground to feed them in, with
little pens to drive them to take them as I wanted, and gates out of one piece
of ground into another.
But this was not all; for now I not only
had goat’s flesh to feed on when I pleased, but milk too—a thing which, indeed,
in the beginning, I did not so much as think of, and which, when it came into
my thoughts, was really an agreeable surprise, for now I set up my dairy, and
had sometimes a gallon or two of milk in a day. And as Nature, who gives
supplies of food to every creature, dictates even naturally how to make use of
it, so I, that had never milked a cow, much less a goat, or seen butter or
cheese made only when I was a boy, after a great many essays and miscarriages,
made both butter and cheese at last, also salt (though I found it partly made
to my hand by the heat of the sun upon some of the rocks of the sea), and never
wanted it afterwards. How mercifully can our Creator treat His creatures, even
in those conditions in which they seemed to be overwhelmed in destruction! How
can He sweeten the bitterest providences, and give us cause to praise Him for
dungeons and prisons! What a table was here spread for me in the wilderness,
where I saw nothing at first but to perish for hunger!
3/4-a Friday-RC-Ch. 10 of 20=
1q "Tames________" What?
Answer= "goats"
2q When/on what day was "the sixth year of his reign"?
Answer= "November 6th"
3q What would they (in 1q) "eat" ?
Answer= "herbage"/something green/greens/vegetables
4q What would they "drink"?
Answer= "water."
5q Why would they need "cover"?
Answer= "to keep them from the sun."
BQ What hasn't he done/eaten since he was a boy?
Answer= " never milked a cow, or a goat, or eaten butter or
cheese."
3/7
CHAPTER XI.
FINDS PRINT OF MAN’S FOOT ON THE SAND
It would have made a Stoic smile to have
seen me and my little family sit down to dinner. There was my majesty the
prince and lord of the whole island; I had the lives of all my subjects at my
absolute command; I could hang, draw, give liberty, and take it away, and no
rebels among all my subjects. Then, to see how like a king I dined, too, all
alone, attended by my servants! Poll, as if he had been my favourite, was the
only person permitted to talk to me. My dog, who was now grown old and crazy,
and had found no species to multiply his kind upon, sat always at my right
hand; and two cats, one on one side of the table and one on the other,
expecting now and then a bit from my hand, as a mark of especial favour.
But these were not the two cats which I
brought on shore at first, for they were both of them dead, and had been
interred near my habitation by my own hand; but one of them having multiplied
by I know not what kind of creature, these were two which I had preserved tame;
whereas the rest ran wild in the woods, and became indeed troublesome to me at
last, for they would often come into my house, and plunder me too, till at last
I was obliged to shoot them, and did kill a great many; at length they left me.
With this attendance and in this plentiful manner I lived; neither could I be
said to want anything but society; and of that, some time after this, I was
likely to have too much.
I was something impatient, as I have
observed, to have the use of my boat, though very loath to run any more hazards;
and therefore sometimes I sat contriving ways to get her about the island, and
at other times I sat myself down contented enough without her. But I had a
strange uneasiness in my mind to go down to the point of the island where, as I
have said in my last ramble, I went up the hill to see how the shore lay, and
how the current set, that I might see what I had to do: this inclination
increased upon me every day, and at length I resolved to travel thither by
land, following the edge of the shore. I did so; but had any one in England met
such a man as I was, it must either have frightened him, or raised a great deal
of laughter; and as I frequently stood still to look at myself, I could not but
smile at the notion of my travelling through Yorkshire with such an equipage,
and in such a dress. Be pleased to take a sketch of my figure, as follows.
I had a great high shapeless cap, made of
a goat’s skin, with a flap hanging down behind, as well to keep the sun from me
as to shoot the rain off from running into my neck, nothing being so hurtful in
these climates as the rain upon the flesh under the clothes.
I had a short jacket of goat’s skin, the
skirts coming down to about the middle of the thighs, and a pair of open-kneed
breeches of the same; the breeches were made of the skin of an old he-goat,
whose hair hung down such a length on either side that, like pantaloons, it
reached to the middle of my legs; stockings and shoes I had none, but had made
me a pair of somethings, I scarce knew what to call them, like buskins, to flap
over my legs, and lace on either side like spatterdashes, but of a most
barbarous shape, as indeed were all the rest of my clothes.
I had on a broad belt of goat’s skin
dried, which I drew together with two thongs of the same instead of buckles,
and in a kind of a frog on either side of this, instead of a sword and dagger,
hung a little saw and a hatchet, one on one side and one on the other. I had
another belt not so broad, and fastened in the same manner, which hung over my
shoulder, and at the end of it, under my left arm, hung two pouches, both made
of goat’s skin too, in one of which hung my powder, in the other my shot. At my
back I carried my basket, and on my shoulder my gun, and over my head a great
clumsy, ugly, goat’s-skin umbrella, but which, after all, was the most
necessary thing I had about me next to my gun. As for my face, the colour of it
was really not so mulatto-like as one might expect from a man not at all
careful of it, and living within nine or ten degrees of the equinox. My beard I
had once suffered to grow till it was about a quarter of a yard long; but as I
had both scissors and razors sufficient, I had cut it pretty short, except what
grew on my upper lip, which I had trimmed into a large pair of Mahometan whiskers,
such as I had seen worn by some Turks at Sallee, for the Moors did not wear
such, though the Turks did; of these moustachios, or whiskers, I will not say
they were long enough to hang my hat upon them, but they were of a length and
shape monstrous enough, and such as in England would have passed for frightful.
But all this is by-the-bye; for as to my
figure, I had so few to observe me that it was of no manner of consequence, so
I say no more of that. In this kind of dress I went my new journey, and was out
five or six days. I travelled first along the sea-shore, directly to the place
where I first brought my boat to an anchor to get upon the rocks; and having no
boat now to take care of, I went over the land a nearer way to the same height
that I was upon before, when, looking forward to the points of the rocks which
lay out, and which I was obliged to double with my boat, as is said above, I
was surprised to see the sea all smooth and quiet—no rippling, no motion, no
current, any more there than in other places. I was at a strange loss to
understand this, and resolved to spend some time in the observing it, to see if
nothing from the sets of the tide had occasioned it; but I was presently
convinced how it was—viz. that the tide of ebb setting from the west, and
joining with the current of waters from some great river on the shore, must be
the occasion of this current, and that, according as the wind blew more
forcibly from the west or from the north, this current came nearer or went
farther from the shore; for, waiting thereabouts till evening, I went up to the
rock again, and then the tide of ebb being made, I plainly saw the current
again as before, only that it ran farther off, being near half a league from
the shore, whereas in my case it set close upon the shore, and hurried me and
my canoe along with it, which at another time it would not have done.
This observation convinced me that I had
nothing to do but to observe the ebbing and the flowing of the tide, and I
might very easily bring my boat about the island again; but when I began to
think of putting it in practice, I had such terror upon my spirits at the
remembrance of the danger I had been in, that I could not think of it again
with any patience, but, on the contrary, I took up another resolution, which
was more safe, though more laborious—and this was, that I would build, or
rather make, me another periagua or canoe, and so have one for one side of the
island, and one for the other.
You are to understand that now I had, as I
may call it, two plantations in the island—one my little fortification or tent,
with the wall about it, under the rock, with the cave behind me, which by this
time I had enlarged into several apartments or caves, one within another. One
of these, which was the driest and largest, and had a door out beyond my wall
or fortification—that is to say, beyond where my wall joined to the rock—was
all filled up with the large earthen pots of which I have given an account, and
with fourteen or fifteen great baskets, which would hold five or six bushels
each, where I laid up my stores of provisions, especially my corn, some in the
ear, cut off short from the straw, and the other rubbed out with my hand.
As for my wall, made, as before, with long
stakes or piles, those piles grew all like trees, and were by this time grown
so big, and spread so very much, that there was not the least appearance, to
any one’s view, of any habitation behind them.
Near this dwelling of mine, but a little
farther within the land, and upon lower ground, lay my two pieces of corn land,
which I kept duly cultivated and sowed, and which duly yielded me their harvest
in its season; and whenever I had occasion for more corn, I had more land
adjoining as fit as that.
Besides this, I had my country seat, and I
had now a tolerable plantation there also; for, first, I had my little bower,
as I called it, which I kept in repair—that is to say, I kept the hedge which
encircled it in constantly fitted up to its usual height, the ladder standing
always in the inside. I kept the trees, which at first were no more than
stakes, but were now grown very firm and tall, always cut, so that they might
spread and grow thick and wild, and make the more agreeable shade, which they
did effectually to my mind. In the middle of this I had my tent always
standing, being a piece of a sail spread over poles, set up for that purpose,
and which never wanted any repair or renewing; and under this I had made me a
squab or couch with the skins of the creatures I had killed, and with other
soft things, and a blanket laid on them, such as belonged to our sea-bedding,
which I had saved; and a great watch-coat to cover me. And here, whenever I had
occasion to be absent from my chief seat, I took up my country habitation.
Adjoining to this I had my enclosures for
my cattle, that is to say my goats, and I had taken an inconceivable deal of
pains to fence and enclose this ground. I was so anxious to see it kept entire,
lest the goats should break through, that I never left off till, with infinite
labour, I had stuck the outside of the hedge so full of small stakes, and so
near to one another, that it was rather a pale than a hedge, and there was
scarce room to put a hand through between them; which afterwards, when those
stakes grew, as they all did in the next rainy season, made the enclosure
strong like a wall, indeed stronger than any wall.
This will testify for me that I was not
idle, and that I spared no pains to bring to pass whatever appeared necessary
for my comfortable support, for I considered the keeping up a breed of tame
creatures thus at my hand would be a living magazine of flesh, milk, butter,
and cheese for me as long as I lived in the place, if it were to be forty
years; and that keeping them in my reach depended entirely upon my perfecting my
enclosures to such a degree that I might be sure of keeping them together;
which by this method, indeed, I so effectually secured, that when these little
stakes began to grow, I had planted them so very thick that I was forced to
pull some of them up again.
In this place also I had my grapes
growing, which I principally depended on for my winter store of raisins, and
which I never failed to preserve very carefully, as the best and most agreeable
dainty of my whole diet; and indeed they were not only agreeable, but
medicinal, wholesome, nourishing, and refreshing to the last degree.
As this was also about half-way between my
other habitation and the place where I had laid up my boat, I generally stayed
and lay here in my way thither, for I used frequently to visit my boat; and I
kept all things about or belonging to her in very good order. Sometimes I went
out in her to divert myself, but no more hazardous voyages would I go, scarcely
ever above a stone’s cast or two from the shore, I was so apprehensive of being
hurried out of my knowledge again by the currents or winds, or any other
accident. But now I come to a new scene of my life.
It happened one day, about noon, going
towards my boat, I was exceedingly surprised with the print of a man’s naked
foot on the shore, which was very plain to be seen on the sand. I stood like
one thunderstruck, or as if I had seen an apparition. I listened, I looked
round me, but I could hear nothing, nor see anything; I went up to a rising
ground to look farther; I went up the shore and down the shore, but it was all
one; I could see no other impression but that one. I went to it again to see if
there were any more, and to observe if it might not be my fancy; but there was
no room for that, for there was exactly the print of a foot—toes, heel, and
every part of a foot. How it came thither I knew not, nor could I in the least
imagine; but after innumerable fluttering thoughts, like a man perfectly
confused and out of myself, I came home to my fortification, not feeling, as we
say, the ground I went on, but terrified to the last degree, looking behind me
at every two or three steps, mistaking every bush and tree, and fancying every
stump at a distance to be a man. Nor is it possible to describe how many
various shapes my affrighted imagination represented things to me in, how many
wild ideas were found every moment in my fancy, and what strange, unaccountable
whimsies came into my thoughts by the way.
When I came to my castle (for so I think I
called it ever after this), I fled into it like one pursued. Whether I went
over by the ladder, as first contrived, or went in at the hole in the rock,
which I had called a door, I cannot remember; no, nor could I remember the next
morning, for never frightened hare fled to cover, or fox to earth, with more
terror of mind than I to this retreat.
I slept none that night; the farther I was
from the occasion of my fright, the greater my apprehensions were, which is
something contrary to the nature of such things, and especially to the usual
practice of all creatures in fear; but I was so embarrassed with my own
frightful ideas of the thing, that I formed nothing but dismal imaginations to
myself, even though I was now a great way off. Sometimes I fancied it must be
the devil, and reason joined in with me in this supposition, for how should any
other thing in human shape come into the place? Where was the vessel that
brought them? What marks were there of any other footstep? And how was it
possible a man should come there? But then, to think that Satan should take
human shape upon him in such a place, where there could be no manner of
occasion for it, but to leave the print of his foot behind him, and that even
for no purpose too, for he could not be sure I should see it—this was an
amusement the other way. I considered that the devil might have found out
abundance of other ways to have terrified me than this of the single print of a
foot; that as I lived quite on the other side of the island, he would never
have been so simple as to leave a mark in a place where it was ten thousand to
one whether I should ever see it or not, and in the sand too, which the first
surge of the sea, upon a high wind, would have defaced entirely. All this
seemed inconsistent with the thing itself and with all the notions we usually
entertain of the subtlety of the devil.
Abundance of such things as these assisted
to argue me out of all apprehensions of its being the devil; and I presently
concluded then that it must be some more dangerous creature—viz. that it must
be some of the savages of the mainland opposite who had wandered out to sea in
their canoes, and either driven by the currents or by contrary winds, had made
the island, and had been on shore, but were gone away again to sea; being as
loath, perhaps, to have stayed in this desolate island as I would have been to
have had them.
While these reflections were rolling in my
mind, I was very thankful in my thoughts that I was so happy as not to be
thereabouts at that time, or that they did not see my boat, by which they would
have concluded that some inhabitants had been in the place, and perhaps have
searched farther for me. Then terrible thoughts racked my imagination about
their having found out my boat, and that there were people here; and that, if
so, I should certainly have them come again in greater numbers and devour me;
that if it should happen that they should not find me, yet they would find my
enclosure, destroy all my corn, and carry away all my flock of tame goats, and
I should perish at last for mere want.
Thus my fear banished all my religious
hope, all that former confidence in God, which was founded upon such wonderful
experience as I had had of His goodness; as if He that had fed me by miracle
hitherto could not preserve, by His power, the provision which He had made for
me by His goodness. I reproached myself with my laziness, that would not sow
any more corn one year than would just serve me till the next season, as if no
accident could intervene to prevent my enjoying the crop that was upon the
ground; and this I thought so just a reproof, that I resolved for the future to
have two or three years’ corn beforehand; so that, whatever might come, I might
not perish for want of bread.
How strange a chequer-work of Providence
is the life of man! and by what secret different springs are the affections
hurried about, as different circumstances present! To-day we love what
to-morrow we hate; to-day we seek what to-morrow we shun; to-day we desire what
to-morrow we fear, nay, even tremble at the apprehensions of. This was
exemplified in me, at this time, in the most lively manner imaginable; for I,
whose only affliction was that I seemed banished from human society, that I was
alone, circumscribed by the boundless ocean, cut off from mankind, and
condemned to what I call silent life; that I was as one whom Heaven thought not
worthy to be numbered among the living, or to appear among the rest of His
creatures; that to have seen one of my own species would have seemed to me a
raising me from death to life, and the greatest blessing that Heaven itself,
next to the supreme blessing of salvation, could bestow; I say, that I should
now tremble at the very apprehensions of seeing a man, and was ready to sink
into the ground at but the shadow or silent appearance of a man having set his
foot in the island.
Such is the uneven state of human life;
and it afforded me a great many curious speculations afterwards, when I had a
little recovered my first surprise. I considered that this was the station of
life the infinitely wise and good providence of God had determined for me; that
as I could not foresee what the ends of Divine wisdom might be in all this, so
I was not to dispute His sovereignty; who, as I was His creature, had an
undoubted right, by creation, to govern and dispose of me absolutely as He
thought fit; and who, as I was a creature that had offended Him, had likewise a
judicial right to condemn me to what punishment He thought fit; and that it was
my part to submit to bear His indignation, because I had sinned against Him. I
then reflected, that as God, who was not only righteous but omnipotent, had
thought fit thus to punish and afflict me, so He was able to deliver me: that
if He did not think fit to do so, it was my unquestioned duty to resign myself
absolutely and entirely to His will; and, on the other hand, it was my duty
also to hope in Him, pray to Him, and quietly to attend to the dictates and
directions of His daily providence.
These thoughts took me up many hours,
days, nay, I may say weeks and months: and one particular effect of my
cogitations on this occasion I cannot omit. One morning early, lying in my bed,
and filled with thoughts about my danger from the appearances of savages, I
found it discomposed me very much; upon which these words of the Scripture came
into my thoughts, “Call upon Me in the day of trouble, and I will deliver thee,
and thou shalt glorify Me.” Upon this, rising cheerfully out of my bed, my
heart was not only comforted, but I was guided and encouraged to pray earnestly
to God for deliverance: when I had done praying I took up my Bible, and opening
it to read, the first words that presented to me were, “Wait on the Lord, and
be of good cheer, and He shall strengthen thy heart; wait, I say, on the Lord.”
It is impossible to express the comfort this gave me. In answer, I thankfully
laid down the book, and was no more sad, at least on that occasion.
In the middle of these cogitations,
apprehensions, and reflections, it came into my thoughts one day that all this
might be a mere chimera of my own, and that this foot might be the print of my
own foot, when I came on shore from my boat: this cheered me up a little, too,
and I began to persuade myself it was all a delusion; that it was nothing else
but my own foot; and why might I not come that way from the boat, as well as I
was going that way to the boat? Again, I considered also that I could by no
means tell for certain where I had trod, and where I had not; and that if, at
last, this was only the print of my own foot, I had played the part of those
fools who try to make stories of spectres and apparitions, and then are
frightened at them more than anybody.
Now I began to take courage, and to peep
abroad again, for I had not stirred out of my castle for three days and nights,
so that I began to starve for provisions; for I had little or nothing within
doors but some barley-cakes and water; then I knew that my goats wanted to be
milked too, which usually was my evening diversion: and the poor creatures were
in great pain and inconvenience for want of it; and, indeed, it almost spoiled
some of them, and almost dried up their milk. Encouraging myself, therefore,
with the belief that this was nothing but the print of one of my own feet, and
that I might be truly said to start at my own shadow, I began to go abroad
again, and went to my country house to milk my flock: but to see with what fear
I went forward, how often I looked behind me, how I was ready every now and
then to lay down my basket and run for my life, it would have made any one have
thought I was haunted with an evil conscience, or that I had been lately most
terribly frightened; and so, indeed, I had. However, I went down thus two or
three days, and having seen nothing, I began to be a little bolder, and to
think there was really nothing in it but my own imagination; but I could not
persuade myself fully of this till I should go down to the shore again, and see
this print of a foot, and measure it by my own, and see if there was any
similitude or fitness, that I might be assured it was my own foot: but when I
came to the place, first, it appeared evidently to me, that when I laid up my
boat I could not possibly be on shore anywhere thereabouts; secondly, when I
came to measure the mark with my own foot, I found my foot not so large by a
great deal. Both these things filled my head with new imaginations, and gave me
the vapours again to the highest degree, so that I shook with cold like one in
an ague; and I went home again, filled with the belief that some man or men had
been on shore there; or, in short, that the island was inhabited, and I might
be surprised before I was aware; and what course to take for my security I knew
not.
Oh, what ridiculous resolutions men take
when possessed with fear! It deprives them of the use of those means which reason
offers for their relief. The first thing I proposed to myself was, to throw
down my enclosures, and turn all my tame cattle wild into the woods, lest the
enemy should find them, and then frequent the island in prospect of the same or
the like booty: then the simple thing of digging up my two corn-fields, lest
they should find such a grain there, and still be prompted to frequent the
island: then to demolish my bower and tent, that they might not see any
vestiges of habitation, and be prompted to look farther, in order to find out
the persons inhabiting.
These were the subject of the first
night’s cogitations after I was come home again, while the apprehensions which
had so overrun my mind were fresh upon me, and my head was full of vapours.
Thus, fear of danger is ten thousand times more terrifying than danger itself,
when apparent to the eyes; and we find the burden of anxiety greater, by much,
than the evil which we are anxious about: and what was worse than all this, I
had not that relief in this trouble that from the resignation I used to
practise I hoped to have. I looked, I thought, like Saul, who complained not
only that the Philistines were upon him, but that God had forsaken him; for I
did not now take due ways to compose my mind, by crying to God in my distress,
and resting upon His providence, as I had done before, for my defence and
deliverance; which, if I had done, I had at least been more cheerfully
supported under this new surprise, and perhaps carried through it with more
resolution.
This confusion of my thoughts kept me
awake all night; but in the morning I fell asleep; and having, by the amusement
of my mind, been as it were tired, and my spirits exhausted, I slept very
soundly, and waked much better composed than I had ever been before. And now I
began to think sedately; and, upon debate with myself, I concluded that this
island (which was so exceedingly pleasant, fruitful, and no farther from the
mainland than as I had seen) was not so entirely abandoned as I might imagine;
that although there were no stated inhabitants who lived on the spot, yet that
there might sometimes come boats off from the shore, who, either with design,
or perhaps never but when they were driven by cross winds, might come to this
place; that I had lived there fifteen years now and had not met with the least
shadow or figure of any people yet; and that, if at any time they should be
driven here, it was probable they went away again as soon as ever they could,
seeing they had never thought fit to fix here upon any occasion; that the most
I could suggest any danger from was from any casual accidental landing of
straggling people from the main, who, as it was likely, if they were driven
hither, were here against their wills, so they made no stay here, but went off
again with all possible speed; seldom staying one night on shore, lest they
should not have the help of the tides and daylight back again; and that,
therefore, I had nothing to do but to consider of some safe retreat, in case I
should see any savages land upon the spot.
Now, I began sorely to repent that I had
dug my cave so large as to bring a door through again, which door, as I said,
came out beyond where my fortification joined to the rock: upon maturely
considering this, therefore, I resolved to draw me a second fortification, in
the manner of a semicircle, at a distance from my wall, just where I had
planted a double row of trees about twelve years before, of which I made
mention: these trees having been planted so thick before, they wanted but few
piles to be driven between them, that they might be thicker and stronger, and
my wall would be soon finished. So that I had now a double wall; and my outer
wall was thickened with pieces of timber, old cables, and everything I could
think of, to make it strong; having in it seven little holes, about as big as I
might put my arm out at. In the inside of this I thickened my wall to about ten
feet thick with continually bringing earth out of my cave, and laying it at the
foot of the wall, and walking upon it; and through the seven holes I contrived
to plant the muskets, of which I took notice that I had got seven on shore out
of the ship; these I planted like my cannon, and fitted them into frames, that
held them like a carriage, so that I could fire all the seven guns in two
minutes’ time; this wall I was many a weary month in finishing, and yet never
thought myself safe till it was done.
When this was done I stuck all the ground
without my wall, for a great length every way, as full with stakes or sticks of
the osier-like wood, which I found so apt to grow, as they could well stand;
insomuch that I believe I might set in near twenty thousand of them, leaving a
pretty large space between them and my wall, that I might have room to see an
enemy, and they might have no shelter from the young trees, if they attempted
to approach my outer wall.
Thus in two years’ time I had a thick
grove; and in five or six years’ time I had a wood before my dwelling, growing
so monstrously thick and strong that it was indeed perfectly impassable: and no
men, of what kind soever, could ever imagine that there was anything beyond it,
much less a habitation. As for the way which I proposed to myself to go in and
out (for I left no avenue), it was by setting two ladders, one to a part of the
rock which was low, and then broke in, and left room to place another ladder
upon that; so when the two ladders were taken down no man living could come
down to me without doing himself mischief; and if they had come down, they were
still on the outside of my outer wall.
Thus I took all the measures human
prudence could suggest for my own preservation; and it will be seen at length
that they were not altogether without just reason; though I foresaw nothing at
that time more than my mere fear suggested to me.
3/7-a Monday-RC- Ch. 11 of 20=
1q What did Robinson Crusoe "find... on the sand"?
Answer= "a man's footprints"
2q What are "spatterdashes"?
Answer= According to
"kidszone.com" (a dictionary for
children), they are like "spats" ("a cloth covering for the
instep & ankles," according to "onelook.com) that were worn by
"soldiers, laborers and sporting men from the late 1760s onward"
3q .What kept him "awake all night"?
Answer= "the
confusion of his thoughts."
4q What "came...off the shore."?
Answer=
"boats."
5q How many holes were there?
Answer= 7
BQ "Thus I took all the measures human ______ could suggest for my own preservation."
Answer= "prudence."
3/8
CHAPTER XII.
A CAVE RETREAT
While this was doing, I was not altogether
careless of my other affairs; for I had a great concern upon me for my little
herd of goats: they were not only a ready supply to me on every occasion, and
began to be sufficient for me, without the expense of powder and shot, but also
without the fatigue of hunting after the wild ones; and I was loath to lose the
advantage of them, and to have them all to nurse up over again.
For this purpose, after long
consideration, I could think of but two ways to preserve them: one was, to find
another convenient place to dig a cave underground, and to drive them into it
every night; and the other was to enclose two or three little bits of land,
remote from one another, and as much concealed as I could, where I might keep
about half-a-dozen young goats in each place; so that if any disaster happened
to the flock in general, I might be able to raise them again with little
trouble and time: and this though it would require a good deal of time and
labour, I thought was the most rational design.
Accordingly, I spent some time to find out
the most retired parts of the island; and I pitched upon one, which was as
private, indeed, as my heart could wish: it was a little damp piece of ground
in the middle of the hollow and thick woods, where, as is observed, I almost
lost myself once before, endeavouring to come back that way from the eastern
part of the island. Here I found a clear piece of land, near three acres, so
surrounded with woods that it was almost an enclosure by nature; at least, it
did not want near so much labour to make it so as the other piece of ground I
had worked so hard at.
I immediately went to work with this piece
of ground; and in less than a month’s time I had so fenced it round that my
flock, or herd, call it which you please, which were not so wild now as at
first they might be supposed to be, were well enough secured in it: so, without
any further delay, I removed ten young she-goats and two he-goats to this
piece, and when they were there I continued to perfect the fence till I had
made it as secure as the other; which, however, I did at more leisure, and it
took me up more time by a great deal. All this labour I was at the expense of,
purely from my apprehensions on account of the print of a man’s foot; for as
yet I had never seen any human creature come near the island; and I had now
lived two years under this uneasiness, which, indeed, made my life much less
comfortable than it was before, as may be well imagined by any who know what it
is to live in the constant snare of the fear of man. And this I must observe,
with grief, too, that the discomposure of my mind had great impression also
upon the religious part of my thoughts; for the dread and terror of falling
into the hands of savages and cannibals lay so upon my spirits, that I seldom
found myself in a due temper for application to my Maker; at least, not with
the sedate calmness and resignation of soul which I was wont to do: I rather
prayed to God as under great affliction and pressure of mind, surrounded with
danger, and in expectation every night of being murdered and devoured before
morning; and I must testify, from my experience, that a temper of peace,
thankfulness, love, and affection, is much the more proper frame for prayer than
that of terror and discomposure: and that under the dread of mischief
impending, a man is no more fit for a comforting performance of the duty of
praying to God than he is for a repentance on a sick-bed; for these
discomposures affect the mind, as the others do the body; and the discomposure
of the mind must necessarily be as great a disability as that of the body, and
much greater; praying to God being properly an act of the mind, not of the
body.
But to go on. After I had thus secured one
part of my little living stock, I went about the whole island, searching for
another private place to make such another deposit; when, wandering more to the
west point of the island than I had ever done yet, and looking out to sea, I
thought I saw a boat upon the sea, at a great distance. I had found a
perspective glass or two in one of the seamen’s chests, which I saved out of
our ship, but I had it not about me; and this was so remote that I could not
tell what to make of it, though I looked at it till my eyes were not able to
hold to look any longer; whether it was a boat or not I do not know, but as I
descended from the hill I could see no more of it, so I gave it over; only I
resolved to go no more out without a perspective glass in my pocket. When I was
come down the hill to the end of the island, where, indeed, I had never been
before, I was presently convinced that the seeing the print of a man’s foot was
not such a strange thing in the island as I imagined: and but that it was a
special providence that I was cast upon the side of the island where the
savages never came, I should easily have known that nothing was more frequent
than for the canoes from the main, when they happened to be a little too far
out at sea, to shoot over to that side of the island for harbour: likewise, as
they often met and fought in their canoes, the victors, having taken any
prisoners, would bring them over to this shore, where, according to their
dreadful customs, being all cannibals, they would kill and eat them; of which
hereafter.
When I was come down the hill to the
shore, as I said above, being the SW. point of the island, I was perfectly
confounded and amazed; nor is it possible for me to express the horror of my
mind at seeing the shore spread with skulls, hands, feet, and other bones of
human bodies; and particularly I observed a place where there had been a fire
made, and a circle dug in the earth, like a cockpit, where I supposed the
savage wretches had sat down to their human feastings upon the bodies of their
fellow-creatures.
I was so astonished with the sight of
these things, that I entertained no notions of any danger to myself from it for
a long while: all my apprehensions were buried in the thoughts of such a pitch
of inhuman, hellish brutality, and the horror of the degeneracy of human
nature, which, though I had heard of it often, yet I never had so near a view
of before; in short, I turned away my face from the horrid spectacle; my
stomach grew sick, and I was just at the point of fainting, when nature
discharged the disorder from my stomach; and having vomited with uncommon
violence, I was a little relieved, but could not bear to stay in the place a
moment; so I got up the hill again with all the speed I could, and walked on
towards my own habitation.
When I came a little out of that part of
the island I stood still awhile, as amazed, and then, recovering myself, I
looked up with the utmost affection of my soul, and, with a flood of tears in
my eyes, gave God thanks, that had cast my first lot in a part of the world
where I was distinguished from such dreadful creatures as these; and that,
though I had esteemed my present condition very miserable, had yet given me so
many comforts in it that I had still more to give thanks for than to complain
of: and this, above all, that I had, even in this miserable condition, been
comforted with the knowledge of Himself, and the hope of His blessing: which
was a felicity more than sufficiently equivalent to all the misery which I had
suffered, or could suffer.
In this frame of thankfulness I went home
to my castle, and began to be much easier now, as to the safety of my
circumstances, than ever I was before: for I observed that these wretches never
came to this island in search of what they could get; perhaps not seeking, not
wanting, or not expecting anything here; and having often, no doubt, been up
the covered, woody part of it without finding anything to their purpose. I knew
I had been here now almost eighteen years, and never saw the least footsteps of
human creature there before; and I might be eighteen years more as entirely
concealed as I was now, if I did not discover myself to them, which I had no
manner of occasion to do; it being my only business to keep myself entirely
concealed where I was, unless I found a better sort of creatures than cannibals
to make myself known to. Yet I entertained such an abhorrence of the savage
wretches that I have been speaking of, and of the wretched, inhuman custom of
their devouring and eating one another up, that I continued pensive and sad,
and kept close within my own circle for almost two years after this: when I say
my own circle, I mean by it my three plantations—viz. my castle, my country
seat (which I called my bower), and my enclosure in the woods: nor did I look
after this for any other use than an enclosure for my goats; for the aversion
which nature gave me to these hellish wretches was such, that I was as fearful
of seeing them as of seeing the devil himself. I did not so much as go to look
after my boat all this time, but began rather to think of making another; for I
could not think of ever making any more attempts to bring the other boat round
the island to me, lest I should meet with some of these creatures at sea; in
which case, if I had happened to have fallen into their hands, I knew what
would have been my lot.
Time, however, and the satisfaction I had
that I was in no danger of being discovered by these people, began to wear off
my uneasiness about them; and I began to live just in the same composed manner
as before, only with this difference, that I used more caution, and kept my
eyes more about me than I did before, lest I should happen to be seen by any of
them; and particularly, I was more cautious of firing my gun, lest any of them,
being on the island, should happen to hear it. It was, therefore, a very good
providence to me that I had furnished myself with a tame breed of goats, and
that I had no need to hunt any more about the woods, or shoot at them; and if I
did catch any of them after this, it was by traps and snares, as I had done
before; so that for two years after this I believe I never fired my gun once
off, though I never went out without it; and what was more, as I had saved
three pistols out of the ship, I always carried them out with me, or at least
two of them, sticking them in my goat-skin belt. I also furbished up one of the
great cutlasses that I had out of the ship, and made me a belt to hang it on
also; so that I was now a most formidable fellow to look at when I went abroad,
if you add to the former description of myself the particular of two pistols,
and a broadsword hanging at my side in a belt, but without a scabbard.
Things going on thus, as I have said, for
some time, I seemed, excepting these cautions, to be reduced to my former calm,
sedate way of living. All these things tended to show me more and more how far
my condition was from being miserable, compared to some others; nay, to many
other particulars of life which it might have pleased God to have made my lot.
It put me upon reflecting how little repining there would be among mankind at
any condition of life if people would rather compare their condition with those
that were worse, in order to be thankful, than be always comparing them with
those which are better, to assist their murmurings and complainings.
As in my present condition there were not
really many things which I wanted, so indeed I thought that the frights I had
been in about these savage wretches, and the concern I had been in for my own
preservation, had taken off the edge of my invention, for my own conveniences;
and I had dropped a good design, which I had once bent my thoughts upon, and
that was to try if I could not make some of my barley into malt, and then try
to brew myself some beer. This was really a whimsical thought, and I reproved
myself often for the simplicity of it: for I presently saw there would be the
want of several things necessary to the making my beer that it would be
impossible for me to supply; as, first, casks to preserve it in, which was a
thing that, as I have observed already, I could never compass: no, though I
spent not only many days, but weeks, nay months, in attempting it, but to no
purpose. In the next place, I had no hops to make it keep, no yeast to make it
work, no copper or kettle to make it boil; and yet with all these things
wanting, I verily believe, had not the frights and terrors I was in about the
savages intervened, I had undertaken it, and perhaps brought it to pass too;
for I seldom gave anything over without accomplishing it, when once I had it in
my head to began it. But my invention now ran quite another way; for night and
day I could think of nothing but how I might destroy some of the monsters in
their cruel, bloody entertainment, and if possible save the victim they should
bring hither to destroy. It would take up a larger volume than this whole work
is intended to be to set down all the contrivances I hatched, or rather brooded
upon, in my thoughts, for the destroying these creatures, or at least
frightening them so as to prevent their coming hither any more: but all this
was abortive; nothing could be possible to take effect, unless I was to be
there to do it myself: and what could one man do among them, when perhaps there
might be twenty or thirty of them together with their darts, or their bows and
arrows, with which they could shoot as true to a mark as I could with my gun?
Sometimes I thought of digging a hole
under the place where they made their fire, and putting in five or six pounds
of gunpowder, which, when they kindled their fire, would consequently take
fire, and blow up all that was near it: but as, in the first place, I should be
unwilling to waste so much powder upon them, my store being now within the
quantity of one barrel, so neither could I be sure of its going off at any certain
time, when it might surprise them; and, at best, that it would do little more
than just blow the fire about their ears and fright them, but not sufficient to
make them forsake the place: so I laid it aside; and then proposed that I would
place myself in ambush in some convenient place, with my three guns all
double-loaded, and in the middle of their bloody ceremony let fly at them, when
I should be sure to kill or wound perhaps two or three at every shot; and then
falling in upon them with my three pistols and my sword, I made no doubt but
that, if there were twenty, I should kill them all. This fancy pleased my
thoughts for some weeks, and I was so full of it that I often dreamed of it,
and, sometimes, that I was just going to let fly at them in my sleep. I went so
far with it in my imagination that I employed myself several days to find out
proper places to put myself in ambuscade, as I said, to watch for them, and I
went frequently to the place itself, which was now grown more familiar to me;
but while my mind was thus filled with thoughts of revenge and a bloody putting
twenty or thirty of them to the sword, as I may call it, the horror I had at
the place, and at the signals of the barbarous wretches devouring one another,
abetted my malice. Well, at length I found a place in the side of the hill
where I was satisfied I might securely wait till I saw any of their boats
coming; and might then, even before they would be ready to come on shore,
convey myself unseen into some thickets of trees, in one of which there was a
hollow large enough to conceal me entirely; and there I might sit and observe
all their bloody doings, and take my full aim at their heads, when they were so
close together as that it would be next to impossible that I should miss my shot,
or that I could fail wounding three or four of them at the first shot. In this
place, then, I resolved to fulfil my design; and accordingly I prepared two
muskets and my ordinary fowling-piece. The two muskets I loaded with a brace of
slugs each, and four or five smaller bullets, about the size of pistol bullets;
and the fowling-piece I loaded with near a handful of swan-shot of the largest
size; I also loaded my pistols with about four bullets each; and, in this
posture, well provided with ammunition for a second and third charge, I
prepared myself for my expedition.
After I had thus laid the scheme of my
design, and in my imagination put it in practice, I continually made my tour
every morning to the top of the hill, which was from my castle, as I called it,
about three miles or more, to see if I could observe any boats upon the sea,
coming near the island, or standing over towards it; but I began to tire of
this hard duty, after I had for two or three months constantly kept my watch,
but came always back without any discovery; there having not, in all that time,
been the least appearance, not only on or near the shore, but on the whole
ocean, so far as my eye or glass could reach every way.
As long as I kept my daily tour to the
hill, to look out, so long also I kept up the vigour of my design, and my
spirits seemed to be all the while in a suitable frame for so outrageous an
execution as the killing twenty or thirty naked savages, for an offence which I
had not at all entered into any discussion of in my thoughts, any farther than
my passions were at first fired by the horror I conceived at the unnatural
custom of the people of that country, who, it seems, had been suffered by
Providence, in His wise disposition of the world, to have no other guide than
that of their own abominable and vitiated passions; and consequently were left,
and perhaps had been so for some ages, to act such horrid things, and receive
such dreadful customs, as nothing but nature, entirely abandoned by Heaven, and
actuated by some hellish degeneracy, could have run them into. But now, when,
as I have said, I began to be weary of the fruitless excursion which I had made
so long and so far every morning in vain, so my opinion of the action itself
began to alter; and I began, with cooler and calmer thoughts, to consider what
I was going to engage in; what authority or call I had to pretend to be judge
and executioner upon these men as criminals, whom Heaven had thought fit for so
many ages to suffer unpunished to go on, and to be as it were the executioners
of His judgments one upon another; how far these people were offenders against
me, and what right I had to engage in the quarrel of that blood which they shed
promiscuously upon one another. I debated this very often with myself thus:
“How do I know what God Himself judges in this particular case? It is certain
these people do not commit this as a crime; it is not against their own
consciences reproving, or their light reproaching them; they do not know it to
be an offence, and then commit it in defiance of divine justice, as we do in
almost all the sins we commit. They think it no more a crime to kill a captive
taken in war than we do to kill an ox; or to eat human flesh than we do to eat
mutton.”
When I considered this a little, it
followed necessarily that I was certainly in the wrong; that these people were
not murderers, in the sense that I had before condemned them in my thoughts,
any more than those Christians were murderers who often put to death the
prisoners taken in battle; or more frequently, upon many occasions, put whole
troops of men to the sword, without giving quarter, though they threw down
their arms and submitted. In the next place, it occurred to me that although
the usage they gave one another was thus brutish and inhuman, yet it was really
nothing to me: these people had done me no injury: that if they attempted, or I
saw it necessary, for my immediate preservation, to fall upon them, something
might be said for it: but that I was yet out of their power, and they really
had no knowledge of me, and consequently no design upon me; and therefore it
could not be just for me to fall upon them; that this would justify the conduct
of the Spaniards in all their barbarities practised in America, where they
destroyed millions of these people; who, however they were idolators and
barbarians, and had several bloody and barbarous rites in their customs, such
as sacrificing human bodies to their idols, were yet, as to the Spaniards, very
innocent people; and that the rooting them out of the country is spoken of with
the utmost abhorrence and detestation by even the Spaniards themselves at this
time, and by all other Christian nations of Europe, as a mere butchery, a
bloody and unnatural piece of cruelty, unjustifiable either to God or man; and
for which the very name of a Spaniard is reckoned to be frightful and terrible,
to all people of humanity or of Christian compassion; as if the kingdom of
Spain were particularly eminent for the produce of a race of men who were
without principles of tenderness, or the common bowels of pity to the
miserable, which is reckoned to be a mark of generous temper in the mind.
3/8-a Tuesday-RC-Ch. 12 of 20=
1q What kind of "Retreat" was it?
Answer= a
"Cave"
2q How many "large candles" did he have?
Answer= 6
3q "there was no _________ or venomous creature to be seen."
Answer= "nauseous"
4q What is "nauseous"?
Answer= According to "onelook.com",
it's "feeling as if you want to vomit."/sick to your stomach
5q How many savages were to (possibly) hunt him?
Answer= 500
BQ What would these savages "never find ___ out"?
Answer= "me" .
3/9
These
considerations really put me to a pause, and to a kind of a full stop; and I
began by little and little to be off my design, and to conclude I had taken
wrong measures in my resolution to attack the savages; and that it was not my
business to meddle with them, unless they first attacked me; and this it was my
business, if possible, to prevent: but that, if I were discovered and attacked by them, I knew my duty. On the other
hand, I argued with myself that this really was the way not to deliver myself,
but entirely to ruin and destroy myself; for unless I was sure to kill every
one that not only should be on shore at that time, but that should ever come on
shore afterwards, if but one of them escaped to tell their country-people what
had happened, they would come over again by thousands to revenge the death of
their fellows, and I should only bring upon myself a certain destruction,
which, at present, I had no manner of occasion for. Upon the whole, I concluded
that I ought, neither in principle nor in policy, one way or other, to concern
myself in this affair: that my business was, by all possible means to conceal
myself from them, and not to leave the least sign for them to guess by that
there were any living creatures upon the island—I mean of human shape. Religion
joined in with this prudential resolution; and I was convinced now, many ways,
that I was perfectly out of my duty when I was laying all my bloody schemes for
the destruction of innocent creatures—I mean innocent as to me. As to the
crimes they were guilty of towards one another, I had nothing to do with them;
they were national, and I ought to leave them to the justice of God, who is the
Governor of nations, and knows how, by national punishments, to make a just
retribution for national offences, and to bring public judgments upon those who
offend in a public manner, by such ways as best please Him. This appeared so
clear to me now, that nothing was a greater satisfaction to me than that I had
not been suffered to do a thing which I now saw so much reason to believe would
have been no less a sin than that of wilful murder if I had committed it; and I
gave most humble thanks on my knees to God, that He had thus delivered me from
blood-guiltiness; beseeching Him to grant me the protection of His providence,
that I might not fall into the hands of the barbarians, or that I might not lay
my hands upon them, unless I had a more clear call from Heaven to do it, in
defence of my own life.
In this disposition I continued for near a
year after this; and so far was I from desiring an occasion for falling upon
these wretches, that in all that time I never once went up the hill to see
whether there were any of them in sight, or to know whether any of them had
been on shore there or not, that I might not be tempted to renew any of my
contrivances against them, or be provoked by any advantage that might present
itself to fall upon them; only this I did: I went and removed my boat, which I
had on the other side of the island, and carried it down to the east end of the
whole island, where I ran it into a little cove, which I found under some high
rocks, and where I knew, by reason of the currents, the savages durst not, at
least would not, come with their boats upon any account whatever. With my boat
I carried away everything that I had left there belonging to her, though not
necessary for the bare going thither—viz. a mast and sail which I had made for
her, and a thing like an anchor, but which, indeed, could not be called either
anchor or grapnel; however, it was the best I could make of its kind: all these
I removed, that there might not be the least shadow for discovery, or appearance
of any boat, or of any human habitation upon the island. Besides this, I kept
myself, as I said, more retired than ever, and seldom went from my cell except
upon my constant employment, to milk my she-goats, and manage my little flock
in the wood, which, as it was quite on the other part of the island, was out of
danger; for certain, it is that these savage people, who sometimes haunted this
island, never came with any thoughts of finding anything here, and consequently
never wandered off from the coast, and I doubt not but they might have been
several times on shore after my apprehensions of them had made me cautious, as
well as before. Indeed, I looked back with some horror upon the thoughts of
what my condition would have been if I had chopped upon them and been
discovered before that; when, naked and unarmed, except with one gun, and that
loaded often only with small shot, I walked everywhere, peeping and peering
about the island, to see what I could get; what a surprise should I have been
in if, when I discovered the print of a man’s foot, I had, instead of that,
seen fifteen or twenty savages, and found them pursuing me, and by the
swiftness of their running no possibility of my escaping them! The thoughts of
this sometimes sank my very soul within me, and distressed my mind so much that
I could not soon recover it, to think what I should have done, and how I should
not only have been unable to resist them, but even should not have had presence
of mind enough to do what I might have done; much less what now, after so much
consideration and preparation, I might be able to do. Indeed, after serious
thinking of these things, I would be melancholy, and sometimes it would last a
great while; but I resolved it all at last into thankfulness to that Providence
which had delivered me from so many unseen dangers, and had kept me from those
mischiefs which I could have no way been the agent in delivering myself from,
because I had not the least notion of any such thing depending, or the least
supposition of its being possible. This renewed a contemplation which often had
come into my thoughts in former times, when first I began to see the merciful
dispositions of Heaven, in the dangers we run through in this life; how
wonderfully we are delivered when we know nothing of it; how, when we are in a
quandary as we call it, a doubt or hesitation whether to go this way or that
way, a secret hint shall direct us this way, when we intended to go that way:
nay, when sense, our own inclination, and perhaps business has called us to go
the other way, yet a strange impression upon the mind, from we know not what
springs, and by we know not what power, shall overrule us to go this way; and
it shall afterwards appear that had we gone that way, which we should have
gone, and even to our imagination ought to have gone, we should have been
ruined and lost. Upon these and many like reflections I afterwards made it a
certain rule with me, that whenever I found those secret hints or pressings of
mind to doing or not doing anything that presented, or going this way or that
way, I never failed to obey the secret dictate; though I knew no other reason
for it than such a pressure or such a hint hung upon my mind. I could give many
examples of the success of this conduct in the course of my life, but more
especially in the latter part of my inhabiting this unhappy island; besides
many occasions which it is very likely I might have taken notice of, if I had
seen with the same eyes then that I see with now. But it is never too late to
be wise; and I cannot but advise all considering men, whose lives are attended
with such extraordinary incidents as mine, or even though not so extraordinary,
not to slight such secret intimations of Providence, let them come from what
invisible intelligence they will. That I shall not discuss, and perhaps cannot
account for; but certainly they are a proof of the converse of spirits, and a
secret communication between those embodied and those unembodied, and such a
proof as can never be withstood; of which I shall have occasion to give some
remarkable instances in the remainder of my solitary residence in this dismal
place.
I believe the reader of this will not
think it strange if I confess that these anxieties, these constant dangers I
lived in, and the concern that was now upon me, put an end to all invention,
and to all the contrivances that I had laid for my future accommodations and
conveniences. I had the care of my safety more now upon my hands than that of
my food. I cared not to drive a nail, or chop a stick of wood now, for fear the
noise I might make should be heard: much less would I fire a gun for the same
reason: and above all I was intolerably uneasy at making any fire, lest the
smoke, which is visible at a great distance in the day, should betray me. For
this reason, I removed that part of my business which required fire, such as
burning of pots and pipes, &c., into my new apartment in the woods; where,
after I had been some time, I found, to my unspeakable consolation, a mere
natural cave in the earth, which went in a vast way, and where, I daresay, no
savage, had he been at the mouth of it, would be so hardy as to venture in;
nor, indeed, would any man else, but one who, like me, wanted nothing so much
as a safe retreat.
The mouth of this hollow was at the bottom
of a great rock, where, by mere accident (I would say, if I did not see
abundant reason to ascribe all such things now to Providence), I was cutting
down some thick branches of trees to make charcoal; and before I go on I must
observe the reason of my making this charcoal, which was this—I was afraid of
making a smoke about my habitation, as I said before; and yet I could not live
there without baking my bread, cooking my meat, &c.; so I contrived to burn
some wood here, as I had seen done in England, under turf, till it became chark
or dry coal: and then putting the fire out, I preserved the coal to carry home,
and perform the other services for which fire was wanting, without danger of
smoke. But this is by-the-bye. While I was cutting down some wood here, I
perceived that, behind a very thick branch of low brushwood or underwood, there
was a kind of hollow place: I was curious to look in it; and getting with
difficulty into the mouth of it, I found it was pretty large, that is to say,
sufficient for me to stand upright in it, and perhaps another with me: but I
must confess to you that I made more haste out than I did in, when looking
farther into the place, and which was perfectly dark, I saw two broad shining
eyes of some creature, whether devil or man I knew not, which twinkled like two
stars; the dim light from the cave’s mouth shining directly in, and making the
reflection. However, after some pause I recovered myself, and began to call
myself a thousand fools, and to think that he that was afraid to see the devil
was not fit to live twenty years in an island all alone; and that I might well
think there was nothing in this cave that was more frightful than myself. Upon
this, plucking up my courage, I took up a firebrand, and in I rushed again, with
the stick flaming in my hand: I had not gone three steps in before I was almost
as frightened as before; for I heard a very loud sigh, like that of a man in
some pain, and it was followed by a broken noise, as of words half expressed,
and then a deep sigh again. I stepped back, and was indeed struck with such a
surprise that it put me into a cold sweat, and if I had had a hat on my head, I
will not answer for it that my hair might not have lifted it off. But still
plucking up my spirits as well as I could, and encouraging myself a little with
considering that the power and presence of God was everywhere, and was able to
protect me, I stepped forward again, and by the light of the firebrand, holding
it up a little over my head, I saw lying on the ground a monstrous, frightful
old he-goat, just making his will, as we say, and gasping for life, and, dying,
indeed, of mere old age. I stirred him a little to see if I could get him out,
and he essayed to get up, but was not able to raise himself; and I thought with
myself he might even lie there—for if he had frightened me, so he would
certainly fright any of the savages, if any of them should be so hardy as to
come in there while he had any life in him.
I was now recovered from my surprise, and
began to look round me, when I found the cave was but very small—that is to
say, it might be about twelve feet over, but in no manner of shape, neither
round nor square, no hands having ever been employed in making it but those of
mere Nature. I observed also that there was a place at the farther side of it
that went in further, but was so low that it required me to creep upon my hands
and knees to go into it, and whither it went I knew not; so, having no candle,
I gave it over for that time, but resolved to go again the next day provided
with candles and a tinder-box, which I had made of the lock of one of the
muskets, with some wildfire in the pan.
Accordingly, the next day I came provided
with six large candles of my own making (for I made very good candles now of
goat’s tallow, but was hard set for candle-wick, using sometimes rags or
rope-yarn, and sometimes the dried rind of a weed like nettles); and going into
this low place I was obliged to creep upon all-fours as I have said, almost ten
yards—which, by the way, I thought was a venture bold enough, considering that
I knew not how far it might go, nor what was beyond it. When I had got through
the strait, I found the roof rose higher up, I believe near twenty feet; but
never was such a glorious sight seen in the island, I daresay, as it was to
look round the sides and roof of this vault or cave—the wall reflected a
hundred thousand lights to me from my two candles. What it was in the
rock—whether diamonds or any other precious stones, or gold which I rather
supposed it to be—I knew not. The place I was in was a most delightful cavity,
or grotto, though perfectly dark; the floor was dry and level, and had a sort
of a small loose gravel upon it, so that there was no nauseous or venomous
creature to be seen, neither was there any damp or wet on the sides or roof.
The only difficulty in it was the entrance—which, however, as it was a place of
security, and such a retreat as I wanted; I thought was a convenience; so that
I was really rejoiced at the discovery, and resolved, without any delay, to
bring some of those things which I was most anxious about to this place:
particularly, I resolved to bring hither my magazine of powder, and all my
spare arms—viz. two fowling-pieces—for I had three in all—and three muskets—for
of them I had eight in all; so I kept in my castle only five, which stood ready
mounted like pieces of cannon on my outmost fence, and were ready also to take
out upon any expedition. Upon this occasion of removing my ammunition I
happened to open the barrel of powder which I took up out of the sea, and which
had been wet, and I found that the water had penetrated about three or four
inches into the powder on every side, which caking and growing hard, had
preserved the inside like a kernel in the shell, so that I had near sixty
pounds of very good powder in the centre of the cask. This was a very agreeable
discovery to me at that time; so I carried all away thither, never keeping
above two or three pounds of powder with me in my castle, for fear of a
surprise of any kind; I also carried thither all the lead I had left for
bullets.
I fancied myself now like one of the
ancient giants who were said to live in caves and holes in the rocks, where
none could come at them; for I persuaded myself, while I was here, that if five
hundred savages were to hunt me, they could never find me out—or if they did,
they would not venture to attack me here. The old goat whom I found expiring
died in the mouth of the cave the next day after I made this discovery; and I
found it much easier to dig a great hole there, and throw him in and cover him
with earth, than to drag him out; so I interred him there, to prevent offence
to my nose.
3/9-a Wednesday-RC-Ch. 13 of 20=
1q The "Wreck" of what?
Answer= "A Spanish Ship"
2q How many gallons of liquor did he have?
Answer= "about 20"
3q What was difficult to put "into my boat"?
Answer= the liquor
4q How many pairs of shoes did he have?
Answer= 2 (or 2x2=4 shoes, 2 pairs of shoes)
5q Which country would he (Robinson Crusoe) "ever escape" to?
Answer= "England."
BQ How many flasks were there?
Answer= 3
3/10
CHAPTER XIII.
WRECK OF A SPANISH SHIP
I was now in the twenty-third year of my
residence in this island, and was so naturalised to the place and the manner of
living, that, could I but have enjoyed the certainty that no savages would come
to the place to disturb me, I could have been content to have capitulated for
spending the rest of my time there, even to the last moment, till I had laid me
down and died, like the old goat in the cave. I had also arrived to some little
diversions and amusements, which made the time pass a great deal more
pleasantly with me than it did before—first, I had taught my Poll, as I noted
before, to speak; and he did it so familiarly, and talked so articulately and
plain, that it was very pleasant to me; and he lived with me no less than
six-and-twenty years. How long he might have lived afterwards I know not,
though I know they have a notion in the Brazils that they live a hundred years.
My dog was a pleasant and loving companion to me for no less than sixteen years
of my time, and then died of mere old age. As for my cats, they multiplied, as
I have observed, to that degree that I was obliged to shoot several of them at
first, to keep them from devouring me and all I had; but at length, when the
two old ones I brought with me were gone, and after some time continually
driving them from me, and letting them have no provision with me, they all ran
wild into the woods, except two or three favourites, which I kept tame, and
whose young, when they had any, I always drowned; and these were part of my
family. Besides these I always kept two or three household kids about me, whom
I taught to feed out of my hand; and I had two more parrots, which talked
pretty well, and would all call “Robin Crusoe,” but none like my first; nor,
indeed, did I take the pains with any of them that I had done with him. I had
also several tame sea-fowls, whose name I knew not, that I caught upon the
shore, and cut their wings; and the little stakes which I had planted before my
castle-wall being now grown up to a good thick grove, these fowls all lived
among these low trees, and bred there, which was very agreeable to me; so that,
as I said above, I began to be very well contented with the life I led, if I
could have been secured from the dread of the savages. But it was otherwise
directed; and it may not be amiss for all people who shall meet with my story
to make this just observation from it: How frequently, in the course of our
lives, the evil which in itself we seek most to shun, and which, when we are
fallen into, is the most dreadful to us, is oftentimes the very means or door
of our deliverance, by which alone we can be raised again from the affliction
we are fallen into. I could give many examples of this in the course of my
unaccountable life; but in nothing was it more particularly remarkable than in
the circumstances of my last years of solitary residence in this island.
It was now the month of December, as I
said above, in my twenty-third year; and this, being the southern solstice (for
winter I cannot call it), was the particular time of my harvest, and required
me to be pretty much abroad in the fields, when, going out early in the
morning, even before it was thorough daylight, I was surprised with seeing a
light of some fire upon the shore, at a distance from me of about two miles,
toward that part of the island where I had observed some savages had been, as
before, and not on the other side; but, to my great affliction, it was on my
side of the island.
I was indeed terribly surprised at the
sight, and stopped short within my grove, not daring to go out, lest I might be
surprised; and yet I had no more peace within, from the apprehensions I had
that if these savages, in rambling over the island, should find my corn
standing or cut, or any of my works or improvements, they would immediately
conclude that there were people in the place, and would then never rest till
they had found me out. In this extremity I went back directly to my castle,
pulled up the ladder after me, and made all things without look as wild and
natural as I could.
Then I prepared myself within, putting
myself in a posture of defence. I loaded all my cannon, as I called them—that
is to say, my muskets, which were mounted upon my new fortification—and all my
pistols, and resolved to defend myself to the last gasp—not forgetting
seriously to commend myself to the Divine protection, and earnestly to pray to
God to deliver me out of the hands of the barbarians. I continued in this
posture about two hours, and began to be impatient for intelligence abroad, for
I had no spies to send out. After sitting a while longer, and musing what I
should do in this case, I was not able to bear sitting in ignorance longer; so
setting up my ladder to the side of the hill, where there was a flat place, as
I observed before, and then pulling the ladder after me, I set it up again and
mounted the top of the hill, and pulling out my perspective glass, which I had
taken on purpose, I laid me down flat on my belly on the ground, and began to
look for the place. I presently found there were no less than nine naked
savages sitting round a small fire they had made, not to warm them, for they had
no need of that, the weather being extremely hot, but, as I supposed, to dress
some of their barbarous diet of human flesh which they had brought with them,
whether alive or dead I could not tell.
They had two canoes with them, which they
had hauled up upon the shore; and as it was then ebb of tide, they seemed to me
to wait for the return of the flood to go away again. It is not easy to imagine
what confusion this sight put me into, especially seeing them come on my side
of the island, and so near to me; but when I considered their coming must be
always with the current of the ebb, I began afterwards to be more sedate in my
mind, being satisfied that I might go abroad with safety all the time of the
flood of tide, if they were not on shore before; and having made this
observation, I went abroad about my harvest work with the more composure.
As I expected, so it proved; for as soon
as the tide made to the westward I saw them all take boat and row (or paddle as
we call it) away. I should have observed, that for an hour or more before they
went off they were dancing, and I could easily discern their postures and
gestures by my glass. I could not perceive, by my nicest observation, but that
they were stark naked, and had not the least covering upon them; but whether
they were men or women I could not distinguish.
As soon as I saw them shipped and gone, I
took two guns upon my shoulders, and two pistols in my girdle, and my great
sword by my side without a scabbard, and with all the speed I was able to make
went away to the hill where I had discovered the first appearance of all; and
as soon as I got thither, which was not in less than two hours (for I could not
go quickly, being so loaded with arms as I was), I perceived there had been
three canoes more of the savages at that place; and looking out farther, I saw
they were all at sea together, making over for the main. This was a dreadful
sight to me, especially as, going down to the shore, I could see the marks of
horror which the dismal work they had been about had left behind it—viz. the
blood, the bones, and part of the flesh of human bodies eaten and devoured by
those wretches with merriment and sport. I was so filled with indignation at
the sight, that I now began to premeditate the destruction of the next that I
saw there, let them be whom or how many soever. It seemed evident to me that
the visits which they made thus to this island were not very frequent, for it
was above fifteen months before any more of them came on shore there again—that
is to say, I neither saw them nor any footsteps or signals of them in all that
time; for as to the rainy seasons, then they are sure not to come abroad, at
least not so far. Yet all this while I lived uncomfortably, by reason of the
constant apprehensions of their coming upon me by surprise: from whence I
observe, that the expectation of evil is more bitter than the suffering,
especially if there is no room to shake off that expectation or those
apprehensions.
During all this time I was in a murdering
humour, and spent most of my hours, which should have been better employed, in
contriving how to circumvent and fall upon them the very next time I should see
them—especially if they should be divided, as they were the last time, into two
parties; nor did I consider at all that if I killed one party—suppose ten or a
dozen—I was still the next day, or week, or month, to kill another, and so
another, even ad infinitum, till I should be, at length, no less a
murderer than they were in being man-eaters—and perhaps much more so. I spent
my days now in great perplexity and anxiety of mind, expecting that I should
one day or other fall into the hands of these merciless creatures; and if I did
at any time venture abroad, it was not without looking around me with the
greatest care and caution imaginable. And now I found, to my great comfort, how
happy it was that I had provided a tame flock or herd of goats, for I durst not
upon any account fire my gun, especially near that side of the island where
they usually came, lest I should alarm the savages; and if they had fled from
me now, I was sure to have them come again with perhaps two or three hundred
canoes with them in a few days, and then I knew what to expect. However, I wore
out a year and three months more before I ever saw any more of the savages, and
then I found them again, as I shall soon observe. It is true they might have
been there once or twice; but either they made no stay, or at least I did not
see them; but in the month of May, as near as I could calculate, and in my four-and-twentieth
year, I had a very strange encounter with them; of which in its place.
The perturbation of my mind during this
fifteen or sixteen months’ interval was very great; I slept unquietly, dreamed
always frightful dreams, and often started out of my sleep in the night. In the
day great troubles overwhelmed my mind; and in the night I dreamed often of
killing the savages and of the reasons why I might justify doing it.
But to waive all this for a while. It was
in the middle of May, on the sixteenth day, I think, as well as my poor wooden
calendar would reckon, for I marked all upon the post still; I say, it was on
the sixteenth of May that it blew a very great storm of wind all day, with a
great deal of lightning and thunder, and; a very foul night it was after it. I
knew not what was the particular occasion of it, but as I was reading in the
Bible, and taken up with very serious thoughts about my present condition, I
was surprised with the noise of a gun, as I thought, fired at sea. This was, to
be sure, a surprise quite of a different nature from any I had met with before;
for the notions this put into my thoughts were quite of another kind. I started
up in the greatest haste imaginable; and, in a trice, clapped my ladder to the
middle place of the rock, and pulled it after me; and mounting it the second
time, got to the top of the hill the very moment that a flash of fire bid me
listen for a second gun, which, accordingly, in about half a minute I heard;
and by the sound, knew that it was from that part of the sea where I was driven
down the current in my boat. I immediately considered that this must be some
ship in distress, and that they had some comrade, or some other ship in
company, and fired these for signals of distress, and to obtain help. I had the
presence of mind at that minute to think, that though I could not help them, it
might be that they might help me; so I brought together all the dry wood I
could get at hand, and making a good handsome pile, I set it on fire upon the
hill. The wood was dry, and blazed freely; and, though the wind blew very hard,
yet it burned fairly out; so that I was certain, if there was any such thing as
a ship, they must needs see it. And no doubt they did; for as soon as ever my
fire blazed up, I heard another gun, and after that several others, all from
the same quarter. I plied my fire all night long, till daybreak: and when it
was broad day, and the air cleared up, I saw something at a great distance at
sea, full east of the island, whether a sail or a hull I could not
distinguish—no, not with my glass: the distance was so great, and the weather
still something hazy also; at least, it was so out at sea.
I looked frequently at it all that day,
and soon perceived that it did not move; so I presently concluded that it was a
ship at anchor; and being eager, you may be sure, to be satisfied, I took my
gun in my hand, and ran towards the south side of the island to the rocks where
I had formerly been carried away by the current; and getting up there, the
weather by this time being perfectly clear, I could plainly see, to my great
sorrow, the wreck of a ship, cast away in the night upon those concealed rocks
which I found when I was out in my boat; and which rocks, as they checked the
violence of the stream, and made a kind of counter-stream, or eddy, were the
occasion of my recovering from the most desperate, hopeless condition that ever
I had been in in all my life. Thus, what is one man’s safety is another man’s
destruction; for it seems these men, whoever they were, being out of their
knowledge, and the rocks being wholly under water, had been driven upon them in
the night, the wind blowing hard at ENE. Had they seen the island, as I must
necessarily suppose they did not, they must, as I thought, have endeavoured to
have saved themselves on shore by the help of their boat; but their firing off
guns for help, especially when they saw, as I imagined, my fire, filled me with
many thoughts. First, I imagined that upon seeing my light they might have put
themselves into their boat, and endeavoured to make the shore: but that the sea
running very high, they might have been cast away. Other times I imagined that
they might have lost their boat before, as might be the case many ways;
particularly by the breaking of the sea upon their ship, which many times
obliged men to stave, or take in pieces, their boat, and sometimes to throw it
overboard with their own hands. Other times I imagined they had some other ship
or ships in company, who, upon the signals of distress they made, had taken
them up, and carried them off. Other times I fancied they were all gone off to
sea in their boat, and being hurried away by the current that I had been
formerly in, were carried out into the great ocean, where there was nothing but
misery and perishing: and that, perhaps, they might by this time think of
starving, and of being in a condition to eat one another.
As all these were but conjectures at best,
so, in the condition I was in, I could do no more than look on upon the misery
of the poor men, and pity them; which had still this good effect upon my side,
that it gave me more and more cause to give thanks to God, who had so happily
and comfortably provided for me in my desolate condition; and that of two
ships’ companies, who were now cast away upon this part of the world, not one
life should be spared but mine. I learned here again to observe, that it is
very rare that the providence of God casts us into any condition so low, or any
misery so great, but we may see something or other to be thankful for, and may
see others in worse circumstances than our own. Such certainly was the case of
these men, of whom I could not so much as see room to suppose any were saved;
nothing could make it rational so much as to wish or expect that they did not
all perish there, except the possibility only of their being taken up by
another ship in company; and this was but mere possibility indeed, for I saw
not the least sign or appearance of any such thing. I cannot explain, by any
possible energy of words, what a strange longing I felt in my soul upon this
sight, breaking out sometimes thus: “Oh that there had been but one or two,
nay, or but one soul saved out of this ship, to have escaped to me, that I
might but have had one companion, one fellow-creature, to have spoken to me and
to have conversed with!” In all the time of my solitary life I never felt so
earnest, so strong a desire after the society of my fellow-creatures, or so
deep a regret at the want of it.
There are some secret springs in the
affections which, when they are set a-going by some object in view, or, though
not in view, yet rendered present to the mind by the power of imagination, that
motion carries out the soul, by its impetuosity, to such violent, eager
embracings of the object, that the absence of it is insupportable. Such were
these earnest wishings that but one man had been saved. I believe I repeated
the words, “Oh that it had been but one!” a thousand times; and my desires were
so moved by it, that when I spoke the words my hands would clinch together, and
my fingers would press the palms of my hands, so that if I had had any soft
thing in my hand I should have crushed it involuntarily; and the teeth in my
head would strike together, and set against one another so strong, that for
some time I could not part them again. Let the naturalists explain these
things, and the reason and manner of them. All I can do is to describe the
fact, which was even surprising to me when I found it, though I knew not from
whence it proceeded; it was doubtless the effect of ardent wishes, and of
strong ideas formed in my mind, realising the comfort which the conversation of
one of my fellow-Christians would have been to me. But it was not to be; either
their fate or mine, or both, forbade it; for, till the last year of my being on
this island, I never knew whether any were saved out of that ship or no; and
had only the affliction, some days after, to see the corpse of a drowned boy
come on shore at the end of the island which was next the shipwreck. He had no
clothes on but a seaman’s waistcoat, a pair of open-kneed linen drawers, and a
blue linen shirt; but nothing to direct me so much as to guess what nation he
was of. He had nothing in his pockets but two pieces of eight and a tobacco
pipe—the last was to me of ten times more value than the first.
It was now calm, and I had a great mind to
venture out in my boat to this wreck, not doubting but I might find something
on board that might be useful to me. But that did not altogether press me so
much as the possibility that there might be yet some living creature on board,
whose life I might not only save, but might, by saving that life, comfort my
own to the last degree; and this thought clung so to my heart that I could not
be quiet night or day, but I must venture out in my boat on board this wreck;
and committing the rest to God’s providence, I thought the impression was so
strong upon my mind that it could not be resisted—that it must come from some
invisible direction, and that I should be wanting to myself if I did not go.
Under the power of this impression, I
hastened back to my castle, prepared everything for my voyage, took a quantity
of bread, a great pot of fresh water, a compass to steer by, a bottle of rum
(for I had still a great deal of that left), and a basket of raisins; and thus,
loading myself with everything necessary. I went down to my boat, got the water
out of her, got her afloat, loaded all my cargo in her, and then went home
again for more. My second cargo was a great bag of rice, the umbrella to set up
over my head for a shade, another large pot of water, and about two dozen of
small loaves, or barley cakes, more than before, with a bottle of goat’s milk
and a cheese; all which with great labour and sweat I carried to my boat; and
praying to God to direct my voyage, I put out, and rowing or paddling the canoe
along the shore, came at last to the utmost point of the island on the
north-east side. And now I was to launch out into the ocean, and either to
venture or not to venture. I looked on the rapid currents which ran constantly
on both sides of the island at a distance, and which were very terrible to me
from the remembrance of the hazard I had been in before, and my heart began to
fail me; for I foresaw that if I was driven into either of those currents, I
should be carried a great way out to sea, and perhaps out of my reach or sight
of the island again; and that then, as my boat was but small, if any little
gale of wind should rise, I should be inevitably lost.
These thoughts so oppressed my mind that I
began to give over my enterprise; and having hauled my boat into a little creek
on the shore, I stepped out, and sat down upon a rising bit of ground, very
pensive and anxious, between fear and desire, about my voyage; when, as I was
musing, I could perceive that the tide was turned, and the flood come on; upon
which my going was impracticable for so many hours. Upon this, presently it
occurred to me that I should go up to the highest piece of ground I could find,
and observe, if I could, how the sets of the tide or currents lay when the
flood came in, that I might judge whether, if I was driven one way out, I might
not expect to be driven another way home, with the same rapidity of the
currents. This thought was no sooner in my head than I cast my eye upon a
little hill which sufficiently overlooked the sea both ways, and from whence I
had a clear view of the currents or sets of the tide, and which way I was to
guide myself in my return. Here I found, that as the current of ebb set out
close by the south point of the island, so the current of the flood set in
close by the shore of the north side; and that I had nothing to do but to keep
to the north side of the island in my return, and I should do well enough.
Encouraged by this observation, I resolved
the next morning to set out with the first of the tide; and reposing myself for
the night in my canoe, under the watch-coat I mentioned, I launched out. I
first made a little out to sea, full north, till I began to feel the benefit of
the current, which set eastward, and which carried me at a great rate; and yet
did not so hurry me as the current on the south side had done before, so as to
take from me all government of the boat; but having a strong steerage with my
paddle, I went at a great rate directly for the wreck, and in less than two
hours I came up to it. It was a dismal sight to look at; the ship, which by its
building was Spanish, stuck fast, jammed in between two rocks. All the stern
and quarter of her were beaten to pieces by the sea; and as her forecastle,
which stuck in the rocks, had run on with great violence, her mainmast and
foremast were brought by the board—that is to say, broken short off; but her
bowsprit was sound, and the head and bow appeared firm. When I came close to
her, a dog appeared upon her, who, seeing me coming, yelped and cried; and as
soon as I called him, jumped into the sea to come to me. I took him into the
boat, but found him almost dead with hunger and thirst. I gave him a cake of my
bread, and he devoured it like a ravenous wolf that had been starving a
fortnight in the snow; I then gave the poor creature some fresh water, with
which, if I would have let him, he would have burst himself. After this I went
on board; but the first sight I met with was two men drowned in the cook-room,
or forecastle of the ship, with their arms fast about one another. I concluded,
as is indeed probable, that when the ship struck, it being in a storm, the sea
broke so high and so continually over her, that the men were not able to bear
it, and were strangled with the constant rushing in of the water, as much as if
they had been under water. Besides the dog, there was nothing left in the ship
that had life; nor any goods, that I could see, but what were spoiled by the
water. There were some casks of liquor, whether wine or brandy I knew not,
which lay lower in the hold, and which, the water being ebbed out, I could see;
but they were too big to meddle with. I saw several chests, which I believe
belonged to some of the seamen; and I got two of them into the boat, without
examining what was in them. Had the stern of the ship been fixed, and the
forepart broken off, I am persuaded I might have made a good voyage; for by
what I found in those two chests I had room to suppose the ship had a great deal
of wealth on board; and, if I may guess from the course she steered, she must
have been bound from Buenos Ayres, or the Rio de la Plata, in the south part of
America, beyond the Brazils to the Havannah, in the Gulf of Mexico, and so
perhaps to Spain. She had, no doubt, a great treasure in her, but of no use, at
that time, to anybody; and what became of the crew I then knew not.
I found, besides these chests, a little
cask full of liquor, of about twenty gallons, which I got into my boat with
much difficulty. There were several muskets in the cabin, and a great
powder-horn, with about four pounds of powder in it; as for the muskets, I had
no occasion for them, so I left them, but took the powder-horn. I took a
fire-shovel and tongs, which I wanted extremely, as also two little brass
kettles, a copper pot to make chocolate, and a gridiron; and with this cargo,
and the dog, I came away, the tide beginning to make home again—and the same
evening, about an hour within night, I reached the island again, weary and
fatigued to the last degree. I reposed that night in the boat and in the
morning I resolved to harbour what I had got in my new cave, and not carry it
home to my castle. After refreshing myself, I got all my cargo on shore, and
began to examine the particulars. The cask of liquor I found to be a kind of
rum, but not such as we had at the Brazils; and, in a word, not at all good;
but when I came to open the chests, I found several things of great use to
me—for example, I found in one a fine case of bottles, of an extraordinary
kind, and filled with cordial waters, fine and very good; the bottles held
about three pints each, and were tipped with silver. I found two pots of very
good succades, or sweetmeats, so fastened also on the top that the salt-water had
not hurt them; and two more of the same, which the water had spoiled. I found
some very good shirts, which were very welcome to me; and about a dozen and a
half of white linen handkerchiefs and coloured neckcloths; the former were also
very welcome, being exceedingly refreshing to wipe my face in a hot day.
Besides this, when I came to the till in the chest, I found there three great
bags of pieces of eight, which held about eleven hundred pieces in all; and in
one of them, wrapped up in a paper, six doubloons of gold, and some small bars
or wedges of gold; I suppose they might all weigh near a pound. In the other
chest were some clothes, but of little value; but, by the circumstances, it
must have belonged to the gunner’s mate; though there was no powder in it,
except two pounds of fine glazed powder, in three flasks, kept, I suppose, for
charging their fowling-pieces on occasion. Upon the whole, I got very little by
this voyage that was of any use to me; for, as to the money, I had no manner of
occasion for it; it was to me as the dirt under my feet, and I would have given
it all for three or four pair of English shoes and stockings, which were things
I greatly wanted, but had had none on my feet for many years. I had, indeed,
got two pair of shoes now, which I took off the feet of two drowned men whom I
saw in the wreck, and I found two pair more in one of the chests, which were
very welcome to me; but they were not like our English shoes, either for ease
or service, being rather what we call pumps than shoes. I found in this
seaman’s chest about fifty pieces of eight, in rials, but no gold: I supposed
this belonged to a poorer man than the other, which seemed to belong to some
officer. Well, however, I lugged this money home to my cave, and laid it up, as
I had done that before which I had brought from our own ship; but it was a
great pity, as I said, that the other part of this ship had not come to my
share: for I am satisfied I might have loaded my canoe several times over with
money; and, thought I, if I ever escape to England, it might lie here safe
enough till I come again and fetch it.
|
3/10-a Thursday-RC- Ch. 14 of 20= 1q What was "Realized"? (note British spelling,"...-sed"/ American spelling ..."-zed") Answer= "A Dream" 2q "we came back to our___________" What? Answer="castle" 3q What are "the Brazils"? Answer= According to
"onelook.com", it's "not
found" so trying "kidzsearch.com"/not kidszone.com" as listed earlier
in 2q of 3/7-- it's "all about the country of Brazil." Where's
Brazil? In South America, so guessing he meant there when he said "the
Brazils". 4q What kind of drawers did he have? Answer= "linen"
(not chest of drawers but men's underwear) 5q Who was "the aptest scholar that ever was"? Answer= his man "Friday", his "new companion." |
|
3/11
CHAPTER XIV.
A DREAM REALISED
Having now brought all my things on shore
and secured them, I went back to my boat, and rowed or paddled her along the
shore to her old harbour, where I laid her up, and made the best of my way to
my old habitation, where I found everything safe and quiet. I began now to
repose myself, live after my old fashion, and take care of my family affairs;
and for a while I lived easy enough, only that I was more vigilant than I used
to be, looked out oftener, and did not go abroad so much; and if at any time I
did stir with any freedom, it was always to the east part of the island, where
I was pretty well satisfied the savages never came, and where I could go
without so many precautions, and such a load of arms and ammunition as I always
carried with me if I went the other way.
I lived in this condition near two years
more; but my unlucky head, that was always to let me know it was born to make
my body miserable, was all these two years filled with projects and designs
how, if it were possible, I might get away from this island: for sometimes I
was for making another voyage to the wreck, though my reason told me that there
was nothing left there worth the hazard of my voyage; sometimes for a ramble
one way, sometimes another—and I believe verily, if I had had the boat that I
went from Sallee in, I should have ventured to sea, bound anywhere, I knew not
whither.
I have been, in all my circumstances, a
memento to those who are touched with the general plague of mankind, whence,
for aught I know, one half of their miseries flow: I mean that of not being
satisfied with the station wherein God and Nature hath placed them—for, not to
look back upon my primitive condition, and the excellent advice of my father,
the opposition to which was, as I may call it, my original sin, my
subsequent mistakes of the same kind had been the means of my coming into this
miserable condition; for had that Providence which so happily seated me at the
Brazils as a planter blessed me with confined desires, and I could have been
contented to have gone on gradually, I might have been by this time—I mean in
the time of my being in this island—one of the most considerable planters in
the Brazils—nay, I am persuaded, that by the improvements I had made in that
little time I lived there, and the increase I should probably have made if I
had remained, I might have been worth a hundred thousand moidores—and what
business had I to leave a settled fortune, a well-stocked plantation, improving
and increasing, to turn supercargo to Guinea to fetch negroes, when patience
and time would have so increased our stock at home, that we could have bought
them at our own door from those whose business it was to fetch them? and though
it had cost us something more, yet the difference of that price was by no means
worth saving at so great a hazard.
But as this is usually the fate of young
heads, so reflection upon the folly of it is as commonly the exercise of more
years, or of the dear-bought experience of time—so it was with me now; and yet
so deep had the mistake taken root in my temper, that I could not satisfy
myself in my station, but was continually poring upon the means and possibility
of my escape from this place; and that I may, with greater pleasure to the
reader, bring on the remaining part of my story, it may not be improper to give
some account of my first conceptions on the subject of this foolish scheme for
my escape, and how, and upon what foundation, I acted.
I am now to be supposed retired into my
castle, after my late voyage to the wreck, my frigate laid up and secured under
water, as usual, and my condition restored to what it was before: I had more
wealth, indeed, than I had before, but was not at all the richer; for I had no
more use for it than the Indians of Peru had before the Spaniards came there.
It was one of the nights in the rainy
season in March, the four-and-twentieth year of my first setting foot in this
island of solitude, I was lying in my bed or hammock, awake, very well in
health, had no pain, no distemper, no uneasiness of body, nor any uneasiness of
mind more than ordinary, but could by no means close my eyes, that is, so as to
sleep; no, not a wink all night long, otherwise than as follows:
It is impossible to set down the
innumerable crowd of thoughts that whirled through that great thoroughfare of
the brain, the memory, in this night’s time. I ran over the whole history of my
life in miniature, or by abridgment, as I may call it, to my coming to this
island, and also of that part of my life since I came to this island. In my
reflections upon the state of my case since I came on shore on this island, I
was comparing the happy posture of my affairs in the first years of my
habitation here, with the life of anxiety, fear, and care which I had lived in
ever since I had seen the print of a foot in the sand. Not that I did not
believe the savages had frequented the island even all the while, and might
have been several hundreds of them at times on shore there; but I had never
known it, and was incapable of any apprehensions about it; my satisfaction was
perfect, though my danger was the same, and I was as happy in not knowing my
danger as if I had never really been exposed to it. This furnished my thoughts
with many very profitable reflections, and particularly this one: How
infinitely good that Providence is, which has provided, in its government of
mankind, such narrow bounds to his sight and knowledge of things; and though he
walks in the midst of so many thousand dangers, the sight of which, if
discovered to him, would distract his mind and sink his spirits, he is kept
serene and calm, by having the events of things hid from his eyes, and knowing
nothing of the dangers which surround him.
After these thoughts had for some time
entertained me, I came to reflect seriously upon the real danger I had been in
for so many years in this very island, and how I had walked about in the
greatest security, and with all possible tranquillity, even when perhaps
nothing but the brow of a hill, a great tree, or the casual approach of night,
had been between me and the worst kind of destruction—viz. that of falling into
the hands of cannibals and savages, who would have seized on me with the same
view as I would on a goat or turtle; and have thought it no more crime to kill
and devour me than I did of a pigeon or a curlew. I would unjustly slander
myself if I should say I was not sincerely thankful to my great Preserver, to
whose singular protection I acknowledged, with great humanity, all these
unknown deliverances were due, and without which I must inevitably have fallen
into their merciless hands.
When these thoughts were over, my head was
for some time taken up in considering the nature of these wretched creatures, I
mean the savages, and how it came to pass in the world that the wise Governor
of all things should give up any of His creatures to such inhumanity—nay, to
something so much below even brutality itself—as to devour its own kind: but as
this ended in some (at that time) fruitless speculations, it occurred to me to
inquire what part of the world these wretches lived in? how far off the coast
was from whence they came? what they ventured over so far from home for? what
kind of boats they had? and why I might not order myself and my business so
that I might be able to go over thither, as they were to come to me?
I never so much as troubled myself to
consider what I should do with myself when I went thither; what would become of
me if I fell into the hands of these savages; or how I should escape them if
they attacked me; no, nor so much as how it was possible for me to reach the
coast, and not to be attacked by some or other of them, without any possibility
of delivering myself; and if I should not fall into their hands, what I should
do for provision, or whither I should bend my course; none of these thoughts, I
say, so much as came in my way; but my mind was wholly bent upon the notion of
my passing over in my boat to the mainland. I looked upon my present condition
as the most miserable that could possibly be; that I was not able to throw
myself into anything but death, that could be called worse; and if I reached
the shore of the main I might perhaps meet with relief, or I might coast along,
as I did on the African shore, till I came to some inhabited country, and where
I might find some relief; and after all, perhaps I might fall in with some
Christian ship that might take me in: and if the worst came to the worst, I
could but die, which would put an end to all these miseries at once. Pray note,
all this was the fruit of a disturbed mind, an impatient temper, made
desperate, as it were, by the long continuance of my troubles, and the
disappointments I had met in the wreck I had been on board of, and where I had
been so near obtaining what I so earnestly longed for—somebody to speak to, and
to learn some knowledge from them of the place where I was, and of the probable
means of my deliverance. I was agitated wholly by these thoughts; all my calm
of mind, in my resignation to Providence, and waiting the issue of the
dispositions of Heaven, seemed to be suspended; and I had as it were no power
to turn my thoughts to anything but to the project of a voyage to the main,
which came upon me with such force, and such an impetuosity of desire, that it
was not to be resisted.
When this had agitated my thoughts for two
hours or more, with such violence that it set my very blood into a ferment, and
my pulse beat as if I had been in a fever, merely with the extraordinary
fervour of my mind about it, Nature—as if I had been fatigued and exhausted
with the very thoughts of it—threw me into a sound sleep. One would have
thought I should have dreamed of it, but I did not, nor of anything relating to
it, but I dreamed that as I was going out in the morning as usual from my
castle, I saw upon the shore two canoes and eleven savages coming to land, and
that they brought with them another savage whom they were going to kill in
order to eat him; when, on a sudden, the savage that they were going to kill
jumped away, and ran for his life; and I thought in my sleep that he came running
into my little thick grove before my fortification, to hide himself; and that I
seeing him alone, and not perceiving that the others sought him that way,
showed myself to him, and smiling upon him, encouraged him: that he kneeled
down to me, seeming to pray me to assist him; upon which I showed him my
ladder, made him go up, and carried him into my cave, and he became my servant;
and that as soon as I had got this man, I said to myself, “Now I may certainly
venture to the mainland, for this fellow will serve me as a pilot, and will
tell me what to do, and whither to go for provisions, and whither not to go for
fear of being devoured; what places to venture into, and what to shun.” I waked
with this thought; and was under such inexpressible impressions of joy at the
prospect of my escape in my dream, that the disappointments which I felt upon
coming to myself, and finding that it was no more than a dream, were equally
extravagant the other way, and threw me into a very great dejection of spirits.
Upon this, however, I made this
conclusion: that my only way to go about to attempt an escape was, to endeavour
to get a savage into my possession: and, if possible, it should be one of their
prisoners, whom they had condemned to be eaten, and should bring hither to kill.
But these thoughts still were attended with this difficulty: that it was
impossible to effect this without attacking a whole caravan of them, and
killing them all; and this was not only a very desperate attempt, and might
miscarry, but, on the other hand, I had greatly scrupled the lawfulness of it
to myself; and my heart trembled at the thoughts of shedding so much blood,
though it was for my deliverance. I need not repeat the arguments which
occurred to me against this, they being the same mentioned before; but though I
had other reasons to offer now—viz. that those men were enemies to my life, and
would devour me if they could; that it was self-preservation, in the highest
degree, to deliver myself from this death of a life, and was acting in my own defence
as much as if they were actually assaulting me, and the like; I say though
these things argued for it, yet the thoughts of shedding human blood for my
deliverance were very terrible to me, and such as I could by no means reconcile
myself to for a great while. However, at last, after many secret disputes with
myself, and after great perplexities about it (for all these arguments, one way
and another, struggled in my head a long time), the eager prevailing desire of
deliverance at length mastered all the rest; and I resolved, if possible, to
get one of these savages into my hands, cost what it would. My next thing was
to contrive how to do it, and this, indeed, was very difficult to resolve on;
but as I could pitch upon no probable means for it, so I resolved to put myself
upon the watch, to see them when they came on shore, and leave the rest to the
event; taking such measures as the opportunity should present, let what would
be.
With these resolutions in my thoughts, I
set myself upon the scout as often as possible, and indeed so often that I was
heartily tired of it; for it was above a year and a half that I waited; and for
great part of that time went out to the west end, and to the south-west corner
of the island almost every day, to look for canoes, but none appeared. This was
very discouraging, and began to trouble me much, though I cannot say that it
did in this case (as it had done some time before) wear off the edge of my
desire to the thing; but the longer it seemed to be delayed, the more eager I
was for it: in a word, I was not at first so careful to shun the sight of these
savages, and avoid being seen by them, as I was now eager to be upon them.
Besides, I fancied myself able to manage one, nay, two or three savages, if I
had them, so as to make them entirely slaves to me, to do whatever I should
direct them, and to prevent their being able at any time to do me any hurt. It
was a great while that I pleased myself with this affair; but nothing still
presented itself; all my fancies and schemes came to nothing, for no savages
came near me for a great while.
About a year and a half after I
entertained these notions (and by long musing had, as it were, resolved them
all into nothing, for want of an occasion to put them into execution), I was
surprised one morning by seeing no less than five canoes all on shore together
on my side the island, and the people who belonged to them all landed and out
of my sight. The number of them broke all my measures; for seeing so many, and
knowing that they always came four or six, or sometimes more in a boat, I could
not tell what to think of it, or how to take my measures to attack twenty or
thirty men single-handed; so lay still in my castle, perplexed and
discomforted. However, I put myself into the same position for an attack that I
had formerly provided, and was just ready for action, if anything had
presented. Having waited a good while, listening to hear if they made any
noise, at length, being very impatient, I set my guns at the foot of my ladder,
and clambered up to the top of the hill, by my two stages, as usual; standing
so, however, that my head did not appear above the hill, so that they could not
perceive me by any means. Here I observed, by the help of my perspective glass,
that they were no less than thirty in number; that they had a fire kindled, and
that they had meat dressed. How they had cooked it I knew not, or what it was;
but they were all dancing, in I know not how many barbarous gestures and
figures, their own way, round the fire.
While I was thus looking on them, I
perceived, by my perspective, two miserable wretches dragged from the boats,
where, it seems, they were laid by, and were now brought out for the slaughter.
I perceived one of them immediately fall; being knocked down, I suppose, with a
club or wooden sword, for that was their way; and two or three others were at
work immediately, cutting him open for their cookery, while the other victim
was left standing by himself, till they should be ready for him. In that very
moment this poor wretch, seeing himself a little at liberty and unbound, Nature
inspired him with hopes of life, and he started away from them, and ran with
incredible swiftness along the sands, directly towards me; I mean towards that
part of the coast where my habitation was. I was dreadfully frightened, I must
acknowledge, when I perceived him run my way; and especially when, as I
thought, I saw him pursued by the whole body: and now I expected that part of
my dream was coming to pass, and that he would certainly take shelter in my
grove; but I could not depend, by any means, upon my dream, that the other
savages would not pursue him thither and find him there. However, I kept my
station, and my spirits began to recover when I found that there was not above
three men that followed him; and still more was I encouraged, when I found that
he outstripped them exceedingly in running, and gained ground on them; so that,
if he could but hold out for half-an-hour, I saw easily he would fairly get
away from them all.
There was between them and my castle the
creek, which I mentioned often in the first part of my story, where I landed my
cargoes out of the ship; and this I saw plainly he must necessarily swim over,
or the poor wretch would be taken there; but when the savage escaping came
thither, he made nothing of it, though the tide was then up; but plunging in,
swam through in about thirty strokes, or thereabouts, landed, and ran with
exceeding strength and swiftness. When the three persons came to the creek, I
found that two of them could swim, but the third could not, and that, standing
on the other side, he looked at the others, but went no farther, and soon after
went softly back again; which, as it happened, was very well for him in the
end. I observed that the two who swam were yet more than twice as strong
swimming over the creek as the fellow was that fled from them. It came very
warmly upon my thoughts, and indeed irresistibly, that now was the time to get
me a servant, and, perhaps, a companion or assistant; and that I was plainly
called by Providence to save this poor creature’s life. I immediately ran down
the ladders with all possible expedition, fetched my two guns, for they were
both at the foot of the ladders, as I observed before, and getting up again with
the same haste to the top of the hill, I crossed towards the sea; and having a
very short cut, and all down hill, placed myself in the way between the
pursuers and the pursued, hallowing aloud to him that fled, who, looking back,
was at first perhaps as much frightened at me as at them; but I beckoned with
my hand to him to come back; and, in the meantime, I slowly advanced towards
the two that followed; then rushing at once upon the foremost, I knocked him
down with the stock of my piece. I was loath to fire, because I would not have
the rest hear; though, at that distance, it would not have been easily heard,
and being out of sight of the smoke, too, they would not have known what to
make of it. Having knocked this fellow down, the other who pursued him stopped,
as if he had been frightened, and I advanced towards him: but as I came nearer,
I perceived presently he had a bow and arrow, and was fitting it to shoot at
me: so I was then obliged to shoot at him first, which I did, and killed him at
the first shot. The poor savage who fled, but had stopped, though he saw both
his enemies fallen and killed, as he thought, yet was so frightened with the
fire and noise of my piece that he stood stock still, and neither came forward
nor went backward, though he seemed rather inclined still to fly than to come
on. I hallooed again to him, and made signs to come forward, which he easily
understood, and came a little way; then stopped again, and then a little
farther, and stopped again; and I could then perceive that he stood trembling,
as if he had been taken prisoner, and had just been to be killed, as his two
enemies were. I beckoned to him again to come to me, and gave him all the signs
of encouragement that I could think of; and he came nearer and nearer, kneeling
down every ten or twelve steps, in token of acknowledgment for saving his life.
I smiled at him, and looked pleasantly, and beckoned to him to come still
nearer; at length he came close to me; and then he kneeled down again, kissed
the ground, and laid his head upon the ground, and taking me by the foot, set
my foot upon his head; this, it seems, was in token of swearing to be my slave
for ever. I took him up and made much of him, and encouraged him all I could.
But there was more work to do yet; for I perceived the savage whom I had
knocked down was not killed, but stunned with the blow, and began to come to
himself: so I pointed to him, and showed him the savage, that he was not dead;
upon this he spoke some words to me, and though I could not understand them,
yet I thought they were pleasant to hear; for they were the first sound of a
man’s voice that I had heard, my own excepted, for above twenty-five years. But
there was no time for such reflections now; the savage who was knocked down
recovered himself so far as to sit up upon the ground, and I perceived that my
savage began to be afraid; but when I saw that, I presented my other piece at
the man, as if I would shoot him: upon this my savage, for so I call him now,
made a motion to me to lend him my sword, which hung naked in a belt by my
side, which I did. He no sooner had it, but he runs to his enemy, and at one
blow cut off his head so cleverly, no executioner in Germany could have done it
sooner or better; which I thought very strange for one who, I had reason to
believe, never saw a sword in his life before, except their own wooden swords:
however, it seems, as I learned afterwards, they make their wooden swords so
sharp, so heavy, and the wood is so hard, that they will even cut off heads
with them, ay, and arms, and that at one blow, too. When he had done this, he
comes laughing to me in sign of triumph, and brought me the sword again, and
with abundance of gestures which I did not understand, laid it down, with the
head of the savage that he had killed, just before me. But that which
astonished him most was to know how I killed the other Indian so far off; so,
pointing to him, he made signs to me to let him go to him; and I bade him go,
as well as I could. When he came to him, he stood like one amazed, looking at
him, turning him first on one side, then on the other; looked at the wound the
bullet had made, which it seems was just in his breast, where it had made a
hole, and no great quantity of blood had followed; but he had bled inwardly,
for he was quite dead. He took up his bow and arrows, and came back; so I
turned to go away, and beckoned him to follow me, making signs to him that more
might come after them. Upon this he made signs to me that he should bury them
with sand, that they might not be seen by the rest, if they followed; and so I
made signs to him again to do so. He fell to work; and in an instant he had
scraped a hole in the sand with his hands big enough to bury the first in, and
then dragged him into it, and covered him; and did so by the other also; I
believe he had him buried them both in a quarter of an hour. Then, calling
away, I carried him, not to my castle, but quite away to my cave, on the
farther part of the island: so I did not let my dream come to pass in that
part, that he came into my grove for shelter. Here I gave him bread and a bunch
of raisins to eat, and a draught of water, which I found he was indeed in great
distress for, from his running: and having refreshed him, I made signs for him
to go and lie down to sleep, showing him a place where I had laid some
rice-straw, and a blanket upon it, which I used to sleep upon myself sometimes;
so the poor creature lay down, and went to sleep.
He was a comely, handsome fellow,
perfectly well made, with straight, strong limbs, not too large; tall, and
well-shaped; and, as I reckon, about twenty-six years of age. He had a very
good countenance, not a fierce and surly aspect, but seemed to have something
very manly in his face; and yet he had all the sweetness and softness of a European
in his countenance, too, especially when he smiled. His hair was long and
black, not curled like wool; his forehead very high and large; and a great
vivacity and sparkling sharpness in his eyes. The colour of his skin was not
quite black, but very tawny; and yet not an ugly, yellow, nauseous tawny, as
the Brazilians and Virginians, and other natives of America are, but of a
bright kind of a dun olive-colour, that had in it something very agreeable,
though not very easy to describe. His face was round and plump; his nose small,
not flat, like the negroes; a very good mouth, thin lips, and his fine teeth
well set, and as white as ivory.
After he had slumbered, rather than slept,
about half-an-hour, he awoke again, and came out of the cave to me, for I had
been milking my goats which I had in the enclosure just by: when he espied me
he came running to me, laying himself down again upon the ground, with all the
possible signs of an humble, thankful disposition, making a great many antic
gestures to show it. At last he lays his head flat upon the ground, close to my
foot, and sets my other foot upon his head, as he had done before; and after
this made all the signs to me of subjection, servitude, and submission
imaginable, to let me know how he would serve me so long as he lived. I
understood him in many things, and let him know I was very well pleased with
him. In a little time I began to speak to him; and teach him to speak to me;
and first, I let him know his name should be Friday, which was the day I saved
his life; I called him so for the memory of the time. I likewise taught him to
say Master; and then let him know that was to be my name; I likewise taught him
to say Yes and No and to know the meaning of them. I gave him some milk in an
earthen pot, and let him see me drink it before him, and sop my bread in it;
and gave him a cake of bread to do the like, which he quickly complied with,
and made signs that it was very good for him. I kept there with him all that
night; but as soon as it was day I beckoned to him to come with me, and let him
know I would give him some clothes; at which he seemed very glad, for he was
stark naked. As we went by the place where he had buried the two men, he
pointed exactly to the place, and showed me the marks that he had made to find
them again, making signs to me that we should dig them up again and eat them.
At this I appeared very angry, expressed my abhorrence of it, made as if I
would vomit at the thoughts of it, and beckoned with my hand to him to come
away, which he did immediately, with great submission. I then led him up to the
top of the hill, to see if his enemies were gone; and pulling out my glass I
looked, and saw plainly the place where they had been, but no appearance of
them or their canoes; so that it was plain they were gone, and had left their
two comrades behind them, without any search after them.
But I was not content with this discovery;
but having now more courage, and consequently more curiosity, I took my man
Friday with me, giving him the sword in his hand, with the bow and arrows at
his back, which I found he could use very dexterously, making him carry one gun
for me, and I two for myself; and away we marched to the place where these
creatures had been; for I had a mind now to get some further intelligence of
them. When I came to the place my very blood ran chill in my veins, and my
heart sunk within me, at the horror of the spectacle; indeed, it was a dreadful
sight, at least it was so to me, though Friday made nothing of it. The place
was covered with human bones, the ground dyed with their blood, and great
pieces of flesh left here and there, half-eaten, mangled, and scorched; and, in
short, all the tokens of the triumphant feast they had been making there, after
a victory over their enemies. I saw three skulls, five hands, and the bones of
three or four legs and feet, and abundance of other parts of the bodies; and
Friday, by his signs, made me understand that they brought over four prisoners
to feast upon; that three of them were eaten up, and that he, pointing to
himself, was the fourth; that there had been a great battle between them and
their next king, of whose subjects, it seems, he had been one, and that they
had taken a great number of prisoners; all which were carried to several places
by those who had taken them in the fight, in order to feast upon them, as was
done here by these wretches upon those they brought hither.
I caused Friday to gather all the skulls,
bones, flesh, and whatever remained, and lay them together in a heap, and make
a great fire upon it, and burn them all to ashes. I found Friday had still a
hankering stomach after some of the flesh, and was still a cannibal in his
nature; but I showed so much abhorrence at the very thoughts of it, and at the
least appearance of it, that he durst not discover it: for I had, by some
means, let him know that I would kill him if he offered it.
When he had done this, we came back to our
castle; and there I fell to work for my man Friday; and first of all, I gave
him a pair of linen drawers, which I had out of the poor gunner’s chest I
mentioned, which I found in the wreck, and which, with a little alteration,
fitted him very well; and then I made him a jerkin of goat’s skin, as well as
my skill would allow (for I was now grown a tolerably good tailor); and I gave
him a cap which I made of hare’s skin, very convenient, and fashionable enough;
and thus he was clothed, for the present, tolerably well, and was mighty well
pleased to see himself almost as well clothed as his master. It is true he went
awkwardly in these clothes at first: wearing the drawers was very awkward to
him, and the sleeves of the waistcoat galled his shoulders and the inside of
his arms; but a little easing them where he complained they hurt him, and using
himself to them, he took to them at length very well.
The next day, after I came home to my
hutch with him, I began to consider where I should lodge him: and that I might
do well for him and yet be perfectly easy myself, I made a little tent for him
in the vacant place between my two fortifications, in the inside of the last,
and in the outside of the first. As there was a door or entrance there into my
cave, I made a formal framed door-case, and a door to it, of boards, and set it
up in the passage, a little within the entrance; and, causing the door to open
in the inside, I barred it up in the night, taking in my ladders, too; so that
Friday could no way come at me in the inside of my innermost wall, without
making so much noise in getting over that it must needs awaken me; for my first
wall had now a complete roof over it of long poles, covering all my tent, and
leaning up to the side of the hill; which was again laid across with smaller
sticks, instead of laths, and then thatched over a great thickness with the
rice-straw, which was strong, like reeds; and at the hole or place which was
left to go in or out by the ladder I had placed a kind of trap-door, which, if
it had been attempted on the outside, would not have opened at all, but would
have fallen down and made a great noise—as to weapons, I took them all into my
side every night. But I needed none of all this precaution; for never man had a
more faithful, loving, sincere servant than Friday was to me: without passions,
sullenness, or designs, perfectly obliged and engaged; his very affections were
tied to me, like those of a child to a father; and I daresay he would have
sacrificed his life to save mine upon any occasion whatsoever—the many
testimonies he gave me of this put it out of doubt, and soon convinced me that I
needed to use no precautions for my safety on his account.
This frequently gave me occasion to
observe, and that with wonder, that however it had pleased God in His
providence, and in the government of the works of His hands, to take from so
great a part of the world of His creatures the best uses to which their
faculties and the powers of their souls are adapted, yet that He has bestowed
upon them the same powers, the same reason, the same affections, the same
sentiments of kindness and obligation, the same passions and resentments of
wrongs, the same sense of gratitude, sincerity, fidelity, and all the
capacities of doing good and receiving good that He has given to us; and that
when He pleases to offer them occasions of exerting these, they are as ready,
nay, more ready, to apply them to the right uses for which they were bestowed
than we are. This made me very melancholy sometimes, in reflecting, as the
several occasions presented, how mean a use we make of all these, even though
we have these powers enlightened by the great lamp of instruction, the Spirit
of God, and by the knowledge of His word added to our understanding; and why it
has pleased God to hide the like saving knowledge from so many millions of
souls, who, if I might judge by this poor savage, would make a much better use
of it than we did. From hence I sometimes was led too far, to invade the
sovereignty of Providence, and, as it were, arraign the justice of so arbitrary
a disposition of things, that should hide that sight from some, and reveal it
to others, and yet expect a like duty from both; but I shut it up, and checked
my thoughts with this conclusion: first, that we did not know by what light and
law these should be condemned; but that as God was necessarily, and by the
nature of His being, infinitely holy and just, so it could not be, but if these
creatures were all sentenced to absence from Himself, it was on account of
sinning against that light which, as the Scripture says, was a law to
themselves, and by such rules as their consciences would acknowledge to be
just, though the foundation was not discovered to us; and secondly, that still
as we all are the clay in the hand of the potter, no vessel could say to him,
“Why hast thou formed me thus?”
But to return to my new companion. I was
greatly delighted with him, and made it my business to teach him everything
that was proper to make him useful, handy, and helpful; but especially to make
him speak, and understand me when I spoke; and he was the aptest scholar that
ever was; and particularly was so merry, so constantly diligent, and so pleased
when he could but understand me, or make me understand him, that it was very
pleasant for me to talk to him. Now my life began to be so easy that I began to
say to myself that could I but have been safe from more savages, I cared not if
I was never to remove from the place where I lived.
3/11-a Friday-RC-Ch. 15 of 20=
1q Who's "Education"?
Answer= "Friday's"
2q What "side of the island"?
Answer= "the east side"
3q Where is Friday from?
Answer= America
4q "Spaniards and______" What?
Answer= "Portuguese"
5q How many miles off the shore was the island?
Answer=40
BQ How long did Robinson Crusoe's boat lay there?
Answer= 22 or 23 years
3/14
CHAPTER XV.
FRIDAY’S EDUCATION
After I had been two or three days
returned to my castle, I thought that, in order to bring Friday off from his
horrid way of feeding, and from the relish of a cannibal’s stomach, I ought to
let him taste other flesh; so I took him out with me one morning to the woods.
I went, indeed, intending to kill a kid out of my own flock; and bring it home
and dress it; but as I was going I saw a she-goat lying down in the shade, and
two young kids sitting by her. I catched hold of Friday. “Hold,” said I, “stand
still;” and made signs to him not to stir: immediately I presented my piece,
shot, and killed one of the kids. The poor creature, who had at a distance,
indeed, seen me kill the savage, his enemy, but did not know, nor could imagine
how it was done, was sensibly surprised, trembled, and shook, and looked so
amazed that I thought he would have sunk down. He did not see the kid I shot
at, or perceive I had killed it, but ripped up his waistcoat to feel whether he
was not wounded; and, as I found presently, thought I was resolved to kill him:
for he came and kneeled down to me, and embracing my knees, said a great many
things I did not understand; but I could easily see the meaning was to pray me
not to kill him.
I soon found a way to convince him that I
would do him no harm; and taking him up by the hand, laughed at him, and
pointing to the kid which I had killed, beckoned to him to run and fetch it,
which he did: and while he was wondering, and looking to see how the creature
was killed, I loaded my gun again. By-and-by I saw a great fowl, like a hawk,
sitting upon a tree within shot; so, to let Friday understand a little what I
would do, I called him to me again, pointed at the fowl, which was indeed a
parrot, though I thought it had been a hawk; I say, pointing to the parrot, and
to my gun, and to the ground under the parrot, to let him see I would make it
fall, I made him understand that I would shoot and kill that bird; accordingly,
I fired, and bade him look, and immediately he saw the parrot fall. He stood like
one frightened again, notwithstanding all I had said to him; and I found he was
the more amazed, because he did not see me put anything into the gun, but
thought that there must be some wonderful fund of death and destruction in that
thing, able to kill man, beast, bird, or anything near or far off; and the
astonishment this created in him was such as could not wear off for a long
time; and I believe, if I would have let him, he would have worshipped me and
my gun. As for the gun itself, he would not so much as touch it for several
days after; but he would speak to it and talk to it, as if it had answered him,
when he was by himself; which, as I afterwards learned of him, was to desire it
not to kill him. Well, after his astonishment was a little over at this, I
pointed to him to run and fetch the bird I had shot, which he did, but stayed
some time; for the parrot, not being quite dead, had fluttered away a good
distance from the place where she fell: however, he found her, took her up, and
brought her to me; and as I had perceived his ignorance about the gun before, I
took this advantage to charge the gun again, and not to let him see me do it,
that I might be ready for any other mark that might present; but nothing more
offered at that time: so I brought home the kid, and the same evening I took
the skin off, and cut it out as well as I could; and having a pot fit for that
purpose, I boiled or stewed some of the flesh, and made some very good broth.
After I had begun to eat some I gave some to my man, who seemed very glad of
it, and liked it very well; but that which was strangest to him was to see me
eat salt with it. He made a sign to me that the salt was not good to eat; and
putting a little into his own mouth, he seemed to nauseate it, and would spit and
sputter at it, washing his mouth with fresh water after it: on the other hand,
I took some meat into my mouth without salt, and I pretended to spit and
sputter for want of salt, as much as he had done at the salt; but it would not
do; he would never care for salt with meat or in his broth; at least, not for a
great while, and then but a very little.
Having thus fed him with boiled meat and
broth, I was resolved to feast him the next day by roasting a piece of the kid:
this I did by hanging it before the fire on a string, as I had seen many people
do in England, setting two poles up, one on each side of the fire, and one
across the top, and tying the string to the cross stick, letting the meat turn
continually. This Friday admired very much; but when he came to taste the
flesh, he took so many ways to tell me how well he liked it, that I could not
but understand him: and at last he told me, as well as he could, he would never
eat man’s flesh any more, which I was very glad to hear.
The next day I set him to work beating
some corn out, and sifting it in the manner I used to do, as I observed before;
and he soon understood how to do it as well as I, especially after he had seen
what the meaning of it was, and that it was to make bread of; for after that I
let him see me make my bread, and bake it too; and in a little time Friday was
able to do all the work for me as well as I could do it myself.
I began now to consider, that having two
mouths to feed instead of one, I must provide more ground for my harvest, and
plant a larger quantity of corn than I used to do; so I marked out a larger
piece of land, and began the fence in the same manner as before, in which
Friday worked not only very willingly and very hard, but did it very
cheerfully: and I told him what it was for; that it was for corn to make more
bread, because he was now with me, and that I might have enough for him and
myself too. He appeared very sensible of that part, and let me know that he
thought I had much more labour upon me on his account than I had for myself;
and that he would work the harder for me if I would tell him what to do.
This was the pleasantest year of all the
life I led in this place. Friday began to talk pretty well, and understand the
names of almost everything I had occasion to call for, and of every place I had
to send him to, and talked a great deal to me; so that, in short, I began now
to have some use for my tongue again, which, indeed, I had very little occasion
for before. Besides the pleasure of talking to him, I had a singular
satisfaction in the fellow himself: his simple, unfeigned honesty appeared to
me more and more every day, and I began really to love the creature; and on his
side I believe he loved me more than it was possible for him ever to love
anything before.
I had a mind once to try if he had any
inclination for his own country again; and having taught him English so well
that he could answer me almost any question, I asked him whether the nation
that he belonged to never conquered in battle? At which he smiled, and
said—“Yes, yes, we always fight the better;” that is, he meant always get the
better in fight; and so we began the following discourse:—
Master.—You always fight the better; how came you to be taken
prisoner, then, Friday?
Friday.—My nation beat much for all that.
Master.—How beat? If your nation beat them, how came you to be
taken?
Friday.—They more many than my nation, in the place where me was;
they take one, two, three, and me: my nation over-beat them in the yonder
place, where me no was; there my nation take one, two, great thousand.
Master.—But why did not your side recover you from the hands of
your enemies, then?
Friday.—They run, one, two, three, and me, and make go in the
canoe; my nation have no canoe that time.
Master.—Well, Friday, and what does your nation do with the men
they take? Do they carry them away and eat them, as these did?
Friday.—Yes, my nation eat mans too; eat all up.
Master.—Where do they carry them?
Friday.—Go to other place, where they think.
Master.—Do they come hither?
Friday.—Yes, yes, they come hither; come other else place.
Master.—Have you been here with them?
Friday.—Yes, I have been here (points to the NW. side of the
island, which, it seems, was their side).
By this I understood that my man Friday
had formerly been among the savages who used to come on shore on the farther
part of the island, on the same man-eating occasions he was now brought for;
and some time after, when I took the courage to carry him to that side, being
the same I formerly mentioned, he presently knew the place, and told me he was
there once, when they ate up twenty men, two women, and one child; he could not
tell twenty in English, but he numbered them by laying so many stones in a row,
and pointing to me to tell them over.
I have told this passage, because it
introduces what follows: that after this discourse I had with him, I asked him
how far it was from our island to the shore, and whether the canoes were not
often lost. He told me there was no danger, no canoes ever lost: but that after
a little way out to sea, there was a current and wind, always one way in the
morning, the other in the afternoon. This I understood to be no more than the
sets of the tide, as going out or coming in; but I afterwards understood it was
occasioned by the great draft and reflux of the mighty river Orinoco, in the
mouth or gulf of which river, as I found afterwards, our island lay; and that
this land, which I perceived to be W. and NW., was the great island Trinidad,
on the north point of the mouth of the river. I asked Friday a thousand
questions about the country, the inhabitants, the sea, the coast, and what
nations were near; he told me all he knew with the greatest openness
imaginable. I asked him the names of the several nations of his sort of people,
but could get no other name than Caribs; from whence I easily understood that
these were the Caribbees, which our maps place on the part of America which
reaches from the mouth of the river Orinoco to Guiana, and onwards to St.
Martha. He told me that up a great way beyond the moon, that was beyond the
setting of the moon, which must be west from their country, there dwelt white
bearded men, like me, and pointed to my great whiskers, which I mentioned
before; and that they had killed much mans, that was his word: by all which I
understood he meant the Spaniards, whose cruelties in America had been spread
over the whole country, and were remembered by all the nations from father to
son.
I inquired if he could tell me how I might
go from this island, and get among those white men. He told me, “Yes, yes, you
may go in two canoe.” I could not understand what he meant, or make him
describe to me what he meant by two canoe, till at last, with great difficulty,
I found he meant it must be in a large boat, as big as two canoes. This part of
Friday’s discourse I began to relish very well; and from this time I
entertained some hopes that, one time or other, I might find an opportunity to
make my escape from this place, and that this poor savage might be a means to
help me.
During the long time that Friday had now
been with me, and that he began to speak to me, and understand me, I was not
wanting to lay a foundation of religious knowledge in his mind; particularly I
asked him one time, who made him. The creature did not understand me at all,
but thought I had asked who was his father—but I took it up by another handle,
and asked him who made the sea, the ground we walked on, and the hills and
woods. He told me, “It was one Benamuckee, that lived beyond all;” he could
describe nothing of this great person, but that he was very old, “much older,”
he said, “than the sea or land, than the moon or the stars.” I asked him then,
if this old person had made all things, why did not all things worship him? He
looked very grave, and, with a perfect look of innocence, said, “All things say
O to him.” I asked him if the people who die in his country went away anywhere?
He said, “Yes; they all went to Benamuckee.” Then I asked him whether those
they eat up went thither too. He said, “Yes.”
From these things, I began to instruct him
in the knowledge of the true God; I told him that the great Maker of all things
lived up there, pointing up towards heaven; that He governed the world by the
same power and providence by which He made it; that He was omnipotent, and
could do everything for us, give everything to us, take everything from us; and
thus, by degrees, I opened his eyes. He listened with great attention, and
received with pleasure the notion of Jesus Christ being sent to redeem us; and
of the manner of making our prayers to God, and His being able to hear us, even
in heaven. He told me one day, that if our God could hear us, up beyond the
sun, he must needs be a greater God than their Benamuckee, who lived but a
little way off, and yet could not hear till they went up to the great mountains
where he dwelt to speak to them. I asked him if ever he went thither to speak
to him. He said, “No; they never went that were young men; none went thither
but the old men,” whom he called their Oowokakee; that is, as I made him
explain to me, their religious, or clergy; and that they went to say O (so he
called saying prayers), and then came back and told them what Benamuckee said.
By this I observed, that there is priestcraft even among the most blinded, ignorant
pagans in the world; and the policy of making a secret of religion, in order to
preserve the veneration of the people to the clergy, not only to be found in
the Roman, but, perhaps, among all religions in the world, even among the most
brutish and barbarous savages.
I endeavoured to clear up this fraud to my
man Friday; and told him that the pretence of their old men going up to the
mountains to say O to their god Benamuckee was a cheat; and their bringing word
from thence what he said was much more so; that if they met with any answer, or
spake with any one there, it must be with an evil spirit; and then I entered
into a long discourse with him about the devil, the origin of him, his
rebellion against God, his enmity to man, the reason of it, his setting himself
up in the dark parts of the world to be worshipped instead of God, and as God,
and the many stratagems he made use of to delude mankind to their ruin; how he
had a secret access to our passions and to our affections, and to adapt his
snares to our inclinations, so as to cause us even to be our own tempters, and
run upon our destruction by our own choice.
3/14-a Monday-RC-Ch.
16 of 20=
1q "Rescue of Prisoners From ___________" What?
Answer= "Cannibals"
2q What was his own property?
Answer= the whole country
3q What were his subjects?
Answer= his people
4q What did Friday do, re supper?
Answer= "boiling & stewing"
5q How many men were there?
Answer=4
BQ How many of them were there?
Answer=100
3/15
I
found it was not so easy to imprint right notions in his mind about the devil
as it was about the being of a God. Nature assisted all my arguments to
evidence to him even the necessity of a great First Cause, an overruling,
governing Power, a secret directing Providence, and of the equity and justice of paying homage to Him that made us, and
the like; but there appeared nothing of this kind in the notion of an evil
spirit, of his origin, his being, his nature, and above all, of his inclination
to do evil, and to draw us in to do so too; and the poor creature puzzled me
once in such a manner, by a question merely natural and innocent, that I scarce
knew what to say to him. I had been talking a great deal to him of the power of
God, His omnipotence, His aversion to sin, His being a consuming fire to the
workers of iniquity; how, as He had made us all, He could destroy us and all
the world in a moment; and he listened with great seriousness to me all the
while. After this I had been telling him how the devil was God’s enemy in the
hearts of men, and used all his malice and skill to defeat the good designs of
Providence, and to ruin the kingdom of Christ in the world, and the like.
“Well,” says Friday, “but you say God is so strong, so great; is He not much
strong, much might as the devil?” “Yes, yes,” says I, “Friday; God is stronger
than the devil—God is above the devil, and therefore we pray to God to tread
him down under our feet, and enable us to resist his temptations and quench his
fiery darts.” “But,” says he again, “if God much stronger, much might as the
wicked devil, why God no kill the devil, so make him no more do wicked?” I was
strangely surprised at this question; and, after all, though I was now an old
man, yet I was but a young doctor, and ill qualified for a casuist or a solver
of difficulties; and at first I could not tell what to say; so I pretended not
to hear him, and asked him what he said; but he was too earnest for an answer
to forget his question, so that he repeated it in the very same broken words as
above. By this time I had recovered myself a little, and I said, “God will at
last punish him severely; he is reserved for the judgment, and is to be cast
into the bottomless pit, to dwell with everlasting fire.” This did not satisfy
Friday; but he returns upon me, repeating my words, “‘Reserve at last!’
me no understand—but why not kill the devil now; not kill great ago?” “You may
as well ask me,” said I, “why God does not kill you or me, when we do wicked
things here that offend Him—we are preserved to repent and be pardoned.” He
mused some time on this. “Well, well,” says he, mighty affectionately, “that
well—so you, I, devil, all wicked, all preserve, repent, God pardon all.” Here
I was run down again by him to the last degree; and it was a testimony to me,
how the mere notions of nature, though they will guide reasonable creatures to
the knowledge of a God, and of a worship or homage due to the supreme being of
God, as the consequence of our nature, yet nothing but divine revelation can
form the knowledge of Jesus Christ, and of redemption purchased for us; of a
Mediator of the new covenant, and of an Intercessor at the footstool of God’s
throne; I say, nothing but a revelation from Heaven can form these in the soul;
and that, therefore, the gospel of our Lord and Saviour Jesus Christ, I mean
the Word of God, and the Spirit of God, promised for the guide and sanctifier
of His people, are the absolutely necessary instructors of the souls of men in
the saving knowledge of God and the means of salvation.
I therefore diverted the present discourse
between me and my man, rising up hastily, as upon some sudden occasion of going
out; then sending him for something a good way off, I seriously prayed to God
that He would enable me to instruct savingly this poor savage; assisting, by
His Spirit, the heart of the poor ignorant creature to receive the light of the
knowledge of God in Christ, reconciling him to Himself, and would guide me so
to speak to him from the Word of God that his conscience might be convinced, his
eyes opened, and his soul saved. When he came again to me, I entered into a
long discourse with him upon the subject of the redemption of man by the
Saviour of the world, and of the doctrine of the gospel preached from Heaven,
viz. of repentance towards God, and faith in our blessed Lord Jesus. I then
explained to him as well as I could why our blessed Redeemer took not on Him
the nature of angels but the seed of Abraham; and how, for that reason, the
fallen angels had no share in the redemption; that He came only to the lost
sheep of the house of Israel, and the like.
I had, God knows, more sincerity than
knowledge in all the methods I took for this poor creature’s instruction, and
must acknowledge, what I believe all that act upon the same principle will
find, that in laying things open to him, I really informed and instructed
myself in many things that either I did not know or had not fully considered
before, but which occurred naturally to my mind upon searching into them, for
the information of this poor savage; and I had more affection in my inquiry
after things upon this occasion than ever I felt before: so that, whether this
poor wild wretch was better for me or no, I had great reason to be thankful
that ever he came to me; my grief sat lighter, upon me; my habitation grew
comfortable to me beyond measure: and when I reflected that in this solitary
life which I have been confined to, I had not only been moved to look up to
heaven myself, and to seek the Hand that had brought me here, but was now to be
made an instrument, under Providence, to save the life, and, for aught I knew,
the soul of a poor savage, and bring him to the true knowledge of religion and
of the Christian doctrine, that he might know Christ Jesus, in whom is life
eternal; I say, when I reflected upon all these things, a secret joy ran
through every part of My soul, and I frequently rejoiced that ever I was
brought to this place, which I had so often thought the most dreadful of all
afflictions that could possibly have befallen me.
I continued in this thankful frame all the
remainder of my time; and the conversation which employed the hours between
Friday and me was such as made the three years which we lived there together
perfectly and completely happy, if any such thing as complete happiness can be
formed in a sublunary state. This savage was now a good Christian, a much
better than I; though I have reason to hope, and bless God for it, that we were
equally penitent, and comforted, restored penitents. We had here the Word of
God to read, and no farther off from His Spirit to instruct than if we had been
in England. I always applied myself, in reading the Scripture, to let him know,
as well as I could, the meaning of what I read; and he again, by his serious
inquiries and questionings, made me, as I said before, a much better scholar in
the Scripture knowledge than I should ever have been by my own mere private
reading. Another thing I cannot refrain from observing here also, from
experience in this retired part of my life, viz. how infinite and inexpressible
a blessing it is that the knowledge of God, and of the doctrine of salvation by
Christ Jesus, is so plainly laid down in the Word of God, so easy to be
received and understood, that, as the bare reading the Scripture made me capable
of understanding enough of my duty to carry me directly on to the great work of
sincere repentance for my sins, and laying hold of a Saviour for life and
salvation, to a stated reformation in practice, and obedience to all God’s
commands, and this without any teacher or instructor, I mean human; so the same
plain instruction sufficiently served to the enlightening this savage creature,
and bringing him to be such a Christian as I have known few equal to him in my
life.
As to all the disputes, wrangling, strife,
and contention which have happened in the world about religion, whether
niceties in doctrines or schemes of church government, they were all perfectly
useless to us, and, for aught I can yet see, they have been so to the rest of
the world. We had the sure guide to heaven, viz. the Word of God; and we had,
blessed be God, comfortable views of the Spirit of God teaching and instructing
by His word, leading us into all truth, and making us both willing and obedient
to the instruction of His word. And I cannot see the least use that the
greatest knowledge of the disputed points of religion, which have made such
confusion in the world, would have been to us, if we could have obtained it.
But I must go on with the historical part of things, and take every part in its
order.
After Friday and I became more intimately
acquainted, and that he could understand almost all I said to him, and speak
pretty fluently, though in broken English, to me, I acquainted him with my own
history, or at least so much of it as related to my coming to this place: how I
had lived there, and how long; I let him into the mystery, for such it was to
him, of gunpowder and bullet, and taught him how to shoot. I gave him a knife,
which he was wonderfully delighted with; and I made him a belt, with a frog
hanging to it, such as in England we wear hangers in; and in the frog, instead
of a hanger, I gave him a hatchet, which was not only as good a weapon in some
cases, but much more useful upon other occasions.
I described to him the country of Europe,
particularly England, which I came from; how we lived, how we worshipped God,
how we behaved to one another, and how we traded in ships to all parts of the
world. I gave him an account of the wreck which I had been on board of, and
showed him, as near as I could, the place where she lay; but she was all beaten
in pieces before, and gone. I showed him the ruins of our boat, which we lost
when we escaped, and which I could not stir with my whole strength then; but
was now fallen almost all to pieces. Upon seeing this boat, Friday stood,
musing a great while, and said nothing. I asked him what it was he studied
upon. At last says he, “Me see such boat like come to place at my nation.” I
did not understand him a good while; but at last, when I had examined further
into it, I understood by him that a boat, such as that had been, came on shore
upon the country where he lived: that is, as he explained it, was driven
thither by stress of weather. I presently imagined that some European ship must
have been cast away upon their coast, and the boat might get loose and drive
ashore; but was so dull that I never once thought of men making their escape
from a wreck thither, much less whence they might come: so I only inquired
after a description of the boat.
Friday described the boat to me well
enough; but brought me better to understand him when he added with some warmth,
“We save the white mans from drown.” Then I presently asked if there were any
white mans, as he called them, in the boat. “Yes,” he said; “the boat full of
white mans.” I asked him how many. He told upon his fingers seventeen. I asked
him then what became of them. He told me, “They live, they dwell at my nation.”
This put new thoughts into my head; for I
presently imagined that these might be the men belonging to the ship that was
cast away in the sight of my island, as I now called it; and who, after the
ship was struck on the rock, and they saw her inevitably lost, had saved
themselves in their boat, and were landed upon that wild shore among the savages.
Upon this I inquired of him more critically what was become of them. He assured
me they lived still there; that they had been there about four years; that the
savages left them alone, and gave them victuals to live on. I asked him how it
came to pass they did not kill them and eat them. He said, “No, they make
brother with them;” that is, as I understood him, a truce; and then he added,
“They no eat mans but when make the war fight;” that is to say, they never eat
any men but such as come to fight with them and are taken in battle.
It was after this some considerable time,
that being upon the top of the hill at the east side of the island, from
whence, as I have said, I had, in a clear day, discovered the main or continent
of America, Friday, the weather being very serene, looks very earnestly towards
the mainland, and, in a kind of surprise, falls a jumping and dancing, and
calls out to me, for I was at some distance from him. I asked him what was the
matter. “Oh, joy!” says he; “Oh, glad! there see my country, there my nation!”
I observed an extraordinary sense of pleasure appeared in his face, and his
eyes sparkled, and his countenance discovered a strange eagerness, as if he had
a mind to be in his own country again. This observation of mine put a great
many thoughts into me, which made me at first not so easy about my new man
Friday as I was before; and I made no doubt but that, if Friday could get back
to his own nation again, he would not only forget all his religion but all his
obligation to me, and would be forward enough to give his countrymen an account
of me, and come back, perhaps with a hundred or two of them, and make a feast
upon me, at which he might be as merry as he used to be with those of his
enemies when they were taken in war. But I wronged the poor honest creature
very much, for which I was very sorry afterwards. However, as my jealousy
increased, and held some weeks, I was a little more circumspect, and not so
familiar and kind to him as before: in which I was certainly wrong too; the
honest, grateful creature having no thought about it but what consisted with
the best principles, both as a religious Christian and as a grateful friend, as
appeared afterwards to my full satisfaction.
While my jealousy of him lasted, you may
be sure I was every day pumping him to see if he would discover any of the new
thoughts which I suspected were in him; but I found everything he said was so
honest and so innocent, that I could find nothing to nourish my suspicion; and
in spite of all my uneasiness, he made me at last entirely his own again; nor
did he in the least perceive that I was uneasy, and therefore I could not
suspect him of deceit.
One day, walking up the same hill, but the
weather being hazy at sea, so that we could not see the continent, I called to
him, and said, “Friday, do not you wish yourself in your own country, your own
nation?” “Yes,” he said, “I be much O glad to be at my own nation.” “What would
you do there?” said I. “Would you turn wild again, eat men’s flesh again, and
be a savage as you were before?” He looked full of concern, and shaking his
head, said, “No, no, Friday tell them to live good; tell them to pray God; tell
them to eat corn-bread, cattle flesh, milk; no eat man again.” “Why, then,”
said I to him, “they will kill you.” He looked grave at that, and then said,
“No, no, they no kill me, they willing love learn.” He meant by this, they
would be willing to learn. He added, they learned much of the bearded mans that
came in the boat. Then I asked him if he would go back to them. He smiled at
that, and told me that he could not swim so far. I told him I would make a
canoe for him. He told me he would go if I would go with him. “I go!” says I;
“why, they will eat me if I come there.” “No, no,” says he, “me make they no eat
you; me make they much love you.” He meant, he would tell them how I had killed
his enemies, and saved his life, and so he would make them love me. Then he
told me, as well as he could, how kind they were to seventeen white men, or
bearded men, as he called them who came on shore there in distress.
From this time, I confess, I had a mind to
venture over, and see if I could possibly join with those bearded men, who I
made no doubt were Spaniards and Portuguese; not doubting but, if I could, we
might find some method to escape from thence, being upon the continent, and a
good company together, better than I could from an island forty miles off the
shore, alone and without help. So, after some days, I took Friday to work again
by way of discourse, and told him I would give him a boat to go back to his own
nation; and, accordingly, I carried him to my frigate, which lay on the other
side of the island, and having cleared it of water (for I always kept it sunk
in water), I brought it out, showed it him, and we both went into it. I found
he was a most dexterous fellow at managing it, and would make it go almost as
swift again as I could. So when he was in, I said to him, “Well, now, Friday,
shall we go to your nation?” He looked very dull at my saying so; which it
seems was because he thought the boat was too small to go so far. I then told
him I had a bigger; so the next day I went to the place where the first boat
lay which I had made, but which I could not get into the water. He said that
was big enough; but then, as I had taken no care of it, and it had lain two or
three and twenty years there, the sun had so split and dried it, that it was
rotten. Friday told me such a boat would do very well, and would carry “much
enough vittle, drink, bread;” this was his way of talking.
3/15-a
Tuesday-RC-Ch. 17 of 20=
1q Who is visiting?
Answer= "mutineers"
2q "Rio de la Plata to_______" Where? (hint- it's in Cuba.)
Answer= "the
Havanna" (Havana, Cuba)
3q How many "Portuguese seamen" were there?
Answer="5"
4q How heavy was "the sugar"?
Answer= "5 or 6 pounds"
5q How many "biscuit-cakes" were there?
Answer= "a few"
BQ What was in the "horn"?
Answer= "powder" (probably gun powder)
3/16
CHAPTER XVI.
RESCUE OF PRISONERS FROM CANNIBALS
Upon the whole, I was by this time so
fixed upon my design of going over with him to the continent that I told him we
would go and make one as big as that, and he should go home in it. He answered
not one word, but looked very grave and sad. I asked him what was the matter
with him. He asked me again, “Why you angry mad with Friday?—what me done?” I
asked him what he meant. I told him I was not angry with him at all. “No
angry!” says he, repeating the words several times; “why send Friday home away
to my nation?” “Why,” says I, “Friday, did not you say you wished you were
there?” “Yes, yes,” says he, “wish we both there; no wish Friday there, no
master there.” In a word, he would not think of going there without me. “I go
there, Friday?” says I; “what shall I do there?” He turned very quick upon me
at this. “You do great deal much good,” says he; “you teach wild mans be good,
sober, tame mans; you tell them know God, pray God, and live new life.” “Alas,
Friday!” says I, “thou knowest not what thou sayest; I am but an ignorant man
myself.” “Yes, yes,” says he, “you teachee me good, you teachee them good.”
“No, no, Friday,” says I, “you shall go without me; leave me here to live by
myself, as I did before.” He looked confused again at that word; and running to
one of the hatchets which he used to wear, he takes it up hastily, and gives it
to me. “What must I do with this?” says I to him. “You take kill Friday,” says
he. “What must kill you for?” said I again. He returns very quick—“What you
send Friday away for? Take kill Friday, no send Friday away.” This he spoke so
earnestly that I saw tears stand in his eyes. In a word, I so plainly
discovered the utmost affection in him to me, and a firm resolution in him,
that I told him then and often after, that I would never send him away from me
if he was willing to stay with me.
Upon the whole, as I found by all his
discourse a settled affection to me, and that nothing could part him from me,
so I found all the foundation of his desire to go to his own country was laid
in his ardent affection to the people, and his hopes of my doing them good; a
thing which, as I had no notion of myself, so I had not the least thought or
intention, or desire of undertaking it. But still I found a strong inclination
to attempting my escape, founded on the supposition gathered from the
discourse, that there were seventeen bearded men there; and therefore, without
any more delay, I went to work with Friday to find out a great tree proper to
fell, and make a large periagua, or canoe, to undertake the voyage. There were
trees enough in the island to have built a little fleet, not of periaguas or
canoes, but even of good, large vessels; but the main thing I looked at was, to
get one so near the water that we might launch it when it was made, to avoid
the mistake I committed at first. At last Friday pitched upon a tree; for I
found he knew much better than I what kind of wood was fittest for it; nor can
I tell to this day what wood to call the tree we cut down, except that it was
very like the tree we call fustic, or between that and the Nicaragua wood, for
it was much of the same colour and smell. Friday wished to burn the hollow or
cavity of this tree out, to make it for a boat, but I showed him how to cut it
with tools; which, after I had showed him how to use, he did very handily; and
in about a month’s hard labour we finished it and made it very handsome;
especially when, with our axes, which I showed him how to handle, we cut and
hewed the outside into the true shape of a boat. After this, however, it cost
us near a fortnight’s time to get her along, as it were inch by inch, upon
great rollers into the water; but when she was in, she would have carried
twenty men with great ease.
When she was in the water, though she was
so big, it amazed me to see with what dexterity and how swift my man Friday
could manage her, turn her, and paddle her along. So I asked him if he would,
and if we might venture over in her. “Yes,” he said, “we venture over in her
very well, though great blow wind.” However I had a further design that he knew
nothing of, and that was, to make a mast and a sail, and to fit her with an
anchor and cable. As to a mast, that was easy enough to get; so I pitched upon
a straight young cedar-tree, which I found near the place, and which there were
great plenty of in the island, and I set Friday to work to cut it down, and
gave him directions how to shape and order it. But as to the sail, that was my
particular care. I knew I had old sails, or rather pieces of old sails, enough;
but as I had had them now six-and-twenty years by me, and had not been very
careful to preserve them, not imagining that I should ever have this kind of
use for them, I did not doubt but they were all rotten; and, indeed, most of
them were so. However, I found two pieces which appeared pretty good, and with
these I went to work; and with a great deal of pains, and awkward stitching,
you may be sure, for want of needles, I at length made a three-cornered ugly
thing, like what we call in England a shoulder-of-mutton sail, to go with a
boom at bottom, and a little short sprit at the top, such as usually our ships’
long-boats sail with, and such as I best knew how to manage, as it was such a
one as I had to the boat in which I made my escape from Barbary, as related in
the first part of my story.
I was near two months performing this last
work, viz. rigging and fitting my masts and sails; for I finished them very
complete, making a small stay, and a sail, or foresail, to it, to assist if we
should turn to windward; and, what was more than all, I fixed a rudder to the
stern of her to steer with. I was but a bungling shipwright, yet as I knew the
usefulness and even necessity of such a thing, I applied myself with so much
pains to do it, that at last I brought it to pass; though, considering the many
dull contrivances I had for it that failed, I think it cost me almost as much
labour as making the boat.
After all this was done, I had my man
Friday to teach as to what belonged to the navigation of my boat; though he
knew very well how to paddle a canoe, he knew nothing of what belonged to a
sail and a rudder; and was the most amazed when he saw me work the boat to and
again in the sea by the rudder, and how the sail jibed, and filled this way or
that way as the course we sailed changed; I say when he saw this he stood like
one astonished and amazed. However, with a little use, I made all these things
familiar to him, and he became an expert sailor, except that of the compass I
could make him understand very little. On the other hand, as there was very
little cloudy weather, and seldom or never any fogs in those parts, there was
the less occasion for a compass, seeing the stars were always to be seen by
night, and the shore by day, except in the rainy seasons, and then nobody cared
to stir abroad either by land or sea.
I was now entered on the
seven-and-twentieth year of my captivity in this place; though the three last
years that I had this creature with me ought rather to be left out of the
account, my habitation being quite of another kind than in all the rest of the
time. I kept the anniversary of my landing here with the same thankfulness to
God for His mercies as at first: and if I had such cause of acknowledgment at
first, I had much more so now, having such additional testimonies of the care
of Providence over me, and the great hopes I had of being effectually and
speedily delivered; for I had an invincible impression upon my thoughts that my
deliverance was at hand, and that I should not be another year in this place. I
went on, however, with my husbandry; digging, planting, and fencing as usual. I
gathered and cured my grapes, and did every necessary thing as before.
The rainy season was in the meantime upon
me, when I kept more within doors than at other times. We had stowed our new
vessel as secure as we could, bringing her up into the creek, where, as I said
in the beginning, I landed my rafts from the ship; and hauling her up to the
shore at high-water mark, I made my man Friday dig a little dock, just big
enough to hold her, and just deep enough to give her water enough to float in;
and then, when the tide was out, we made a strong dam across the end of it, to
keep the water out; and so she lay, dry as to the tide from the sea: and to
keep the rain off we laid a great many boughs of trees, so thick that she was
as well thatched as a house; and thus we waited for the months of November and
December, in which I designed to make my adventure.
When the settled season began to come in,
as the thought of my design returned with the fair weather, I was preparing
daily for the voyage. And the first thing I did was to lay by a certain
quantity of provisions, being the stores for our voyage; and intended in a week
or a fortnight’s time to open the dock, and launch out our boat. I was busy one
morning upon something of this kind, when I called to Friday, and bid him to go
to the sea-shore and see if he could find a turtle or a tortoise, a thing which
we generally got once a week, for the sake of the eggs as well as the flesh.
Friday had not been long gone when he came running back, and flew over my outer
wall or fence, like one that felt not the ground or the steps he set his foot
on; and before I had time to speak to him he cries out to me, “O master! O
master! O sorrow! O bad!”—“What’s the matter, Friday?” says I. “O yonder
there,” says he, “one, two, three canoes; one, two, three!” By this way of
speaking I concluded there were six; but on inquiry I found there were but
three. “Well, Friday,” says I, “do not be frightened.” So I heartened him up as
well as I could. However, I saw the poor fellow was most terribly scared, for
nothing ran in his head but that they were come to look for him, and would cut him
in pieces and eat him; and the poor fellow trembled so that I scarcely knew
what to do with him. I comforted him as well as I could, and told him I was in
as much danger as he, and that they would eat me as well as him. “But,” says I,
“Friday, we must resolve to fight them. Can you fight, Friday?” “Me shoot,”
says he, “but there come many great number.” “No matter for that,” said I
again; “our guns will fright them that we do not kill.” So I asked him whether,
if I resolved to defend him, he would defend me, and stand by me, and do just
as I bid him. He said, “Me die when you bid die, master.” So I went and fetched
a good dram of rum and gave him; for I had been so good a husband of my rum
that I had a great deal left. When we had drunk it, I made him take the two
fowling-pieces, which we always carried, and loaded them with large swan-shot,
as big as small pistol-bullets. Then I took four muskets, and loaded them with
two slugs and five small bullets each; and my two pistols I loaded with a brace
of bullets each. I hung my great sword, as usual, naked by my side, and gave
Friday his hatchet. When I had thus prepared myself, I took my perspective
glass, and went up to the side of the hill, to see what I could discover; and I
found quickly by my glass that there were one-and-twenty savages, three
prisoners, and three canoes; and that their whole business seemed to be the
triumphant banquet upon these three human bodies: a barbarous feast, indeed!
but nothing more than, as I had observed, was usual with them. I observed also
that they had landed, not where they had done when Friday made his escape, but
nearer to my creek, where the shore was low, and where a thick wood came almost
close down to the sea. This, with the abhorrence of the inhuman errand these wretches
came about, filled me with such indignation that I came down again to Friday,
and told him I was resolved to go down to them and kill them all; and asked him
if he would stand by me. He had now got over his fright, and his spirits being
a little raised with the dram I had given him, he was very cheerful, and told
me, as before, he would die when I bid die.
In this fit of fury I divided the arms
which I had charged, as before, between us; I gave Friday one pistol to stick
in his girdle, and three guns upon his shoulder, and I took one pistol and the
other three guns myself; and in this posture we marched out. I took a small
bottle of rum in my pocket, and gave Friday a large bag with more powder and
bullets; and as to orders, I charged him to keep close behind me, and not to
stir, or shoot, or do anything till I bid him, and in the meantime not to speak
a word. In this posture I fetched a compass to my right hand of near a mile, as
well to get over the creek as to get into the wood, so that I could come within
shot of them before I should be discovered, which I had seen by my glass it was
easy to do.
While I was making this march, my former
thoughts returning, I began to abate my resolution: I do not mean that I
entertained any fear of their number, for as they were naked, unarmed wretches,
it is certain I was superior to them—nay, though I had been alone. But it
occurred to my thoughts, what call, what occasion, much less what necessity I
was in to go and dip my hands in blood, to attack people who had neither done
or intended me any wrong? who, as to me, were innocent, and whose barbarous
customs were their own disaster, being in them a token, indeed, of God’s having
left them, with the other nations of that part of the world, to such stupidity,
and to such inhuman courses, but did not call me to take upon me to be a judge
of their actions, much less an executioner of His justice—that whenever He
thought fit He would take the cause into His own hands, and by national
vengeance punish them as a people for national crimes, but that, in the
meantime, it was none of my business—that it was true Friday might justify it,
because he was a declared enemy and in a state of war with those very
particular people, and it was lawful for him to attack them—but I could not say
the same with regard to myself. These things were so warmly pressed upon my
thoughts all the way as I went, that I resolved I would only go and place
myself near them that I might observe their barbarous feast, and that I would
act then as God should direct; but that unless something offered that was more
a call to me than yet I knew of, I would not meddle with them.
With this resolution I entered the wood,
and, with all possible wariness and silence, Friday following close at my
heels, I marched till I came to the skirts of the wood on the side which was
next to them, only that one corner of the wood lay between me and them. Here I
called softly to Friday, and showing him a great tree which was just at the
corner of the wood, I bade him go to the tree, and bring me word if he could
see there plainly what they were doing. He did so, and came immediately back to
me, and told me they might be plainly viewed there—that they were all about
their fire, eating the flesh of one of their prisoners, and that another lay
bound upon the sand a little from them, whom he said they would kill next; and
this fired the very soul within me. He told me it was not one of their nation,
but one of the bearded men he had told me of, that came to their country in the
boat. I was filled with horror at the very naming of the white bearded man; and
going to the tree, I saw plainly by my glass a white man, who lay upon the
beach of the sea with his hands and his feet tied with flags, or things like
rushes, and that he was an European, and had clothes on.
There was another tree and a little
thicket beyond it, about fifty yards nearer to them than the place where I was,
which, by going a little way about, I saw I might come at undiscovered, and
that then I should be within half a shot of them; so I withheld my passion,
though I was indeed enraged to the highest degree; and going back about twenty
paces, I got behind some bushes, which held all the way till I came to the
other tree, and then came to a little rising ground, which gave me a full view
of them at the distance of about eighty yards.
I had now not a moment to lose, for
nineteen of the dreadful wretches sat upon the ground, all close huddled
together, and had just sent the other two to butcher the poor Christian, and
bring him perhaps limb by limb to their fire, and they were stooping down to
untie the bands at his feet. I turned to Friday. “Now, Friday,” said I, “do as
I bid thee.” Friday said he would. “Then, Friday,” says I, “do exactly as you
see me do; fail in nothing.” So I set down one of the muskets and the
fowling-piece upon the ground, and Friday did the like by his, and with the
other musket I took my aim at the savages, bidding him to do the like; then
asking him if he was ready, he said, “Yes.” “Then fire at them,” said I; and at
the same moment I fired also.
3/16-a
Wednesday-RC-Ch. 18 of 20=
1q What was "recovered"?
Answer= "the ship"
2q How many "muskets" (guns) were there?
Answer="5"
3q How many "fowling-pieces" (shotguns for shooting small animals, like birds) were there?
Answer= "3"
4q How many "swords" were there?
Answer= "3"
5q "milk and butter and_________" What?
Answer="cheese"
BQ How many "barrels of gunpowder more"?
Answer= "2"
3/17
Friday
took his aim so much better than I, that on the side that he shot he killed two
of them, and wounded three more; and on my side I killed one, and wounded two.
They were, you may be sure, in a dreadful consternation: and all of them that were not hurt
jumped upon their feet, but did not immediately know which way to run, or which
way to look, for they knew not from whence their destruction came. Friday kept
his eyes close upon me, that, as I had bid him, he might observe what I did;
so, as soon as the first shot was made, I threw down the piece, and took up the
fowling-piece, and Friday did the like; he saw me cock and present; he did the
same again. “Are you ready, Friday?” said I. “Yes,” says he. “Let fly, then,”
says I, “in the name of God!” and with that I fired again among the amazed
wretches, and so did Friday; and as our pieces were now loaded with what I call
swan-shot, or small pistol-bullets, we found only two drop; but so many were
wounded that they ran about yelling and screaming like mad creatures, all
bloody, and most of them miserably wounded; whereof three more fell quickly
after, though not quite dead.
“Now, Friday,” says I, laying down the
discharged pieces, and taking up the musket which was yet loaded, “follow me,”
which he did with a great deal of courage; upon which I rushed out of the wood
and showed myself, and Friday close at my foot. As soon as I perceived they saw
me, I shouted as loud as I could, and bade Friday do so too, and running as
fast as I could, which, by the way, was not very fast, being loaded with arms
as I was, I made directly towards the poor victim, who was, as I said, lying
upon the beach or shore, between the place where they sat and the sea. The two
butchers who were just going to work with him had left him at the surprise of
our first fire, and fled in a terrible fright to the seaside, and had jumped
into a canoe, and three more of the rest made the same way. I turned to Friday,
and bade him step forwards and fire at them; he understood me immediately, and
running about forty yards, to be nearer them, he shot at them; and I thought he
had killed them all, for I saw them all fall of a heap into the boat, though I
saw two of them up again quickly; however, he killed two of them, and wounded
the third, so that he lay down in the bottom of the boat as if he had been
dead.
While my man Friday fired at them, I
pulled out my knife and cut the flags that bound the poor victim; and loosing
his hands and feet, I lifted him up, and asked him in the Portuguese tongue
what he was. He answered in Latin, Christianus; but was so weak and faint that
he could scarce stand or speak. I took my bottle out of my pocket and gave it
him, making signs that he should drink, which he did; and I gave him a piece of
bread, which he ate. Then I asked him what countryman he was: and he said,
Espagniole; and being a little recovered, let me know, by all the signs he
could possibly make, how much he was in my debt for his deliverance.
“Seignior,” said I, with as much Spanish as I could make up, “we will talk
afterwards, but we must fight now: if you have any strength left, take this
pistol and sword, and lay about you.” He took them very thankfully; and no
sooner had he the arms in his hands, but, as if they had put new vigour into
him, he flew upon his murderers like a fury, and had cut two of them in pieces
in an instant; for the truth is, as the whole was a surprise to them, so the
poor creatures were so much frightened with the noise of our pieces that they
fell down for mere amazement and fear, and had no more power to attempt their
own escape than their flesh had to resist our shot; and that was the case of
those five that Friday shot at in the boat; for as three of them fell with the
hurt they received, so the other two fell with the fright.
I kept my piece in my hand still without
firing, being willing to keep my charge ready, because I had given the Spaniard
my pistol and sword: so I called to Friday, and bade him run up to the tree
from whence we first fired, and fetch the arms which lay there that had been
discharged, which he did with great swiftness; and then giving him my musket, I
sat down myself to load all the rest again, and bade them come to me when they
wanted. While I was loading these pieces, there happened a fierce engagement
between the Spaniard and one of the savages, who made at him with one of their
great wooden swords, the weapon that was to have killed him before, if I had
not prevented it. The Spaniard, who was as bold and brave as could be imagined,
though weak, had fought the Indian a good while, and had cut two great wounds
on his head; but the savage being a stout, lusty fellow, closing in with him,
had thrown him down, being faint, and was wringing my sword out of his hand;
when the Spaniard, though undermost, wisely quitting the sword, drew the pistol
from his girdle, shot the savage through the body, and killed him upon the
spot, before I, who was running to help him, could come near him.
Friday, being now left to his liberty,
pursued the flying wretches, with no weapon in his hand but his hatchet: and
with that he despatched those three who as I said before, were wounded at
first, and fallen, and all the rest he could come up with: and the Spaniard
coming to me for a gun, I gave him one of the fowling-pieces, with which he
pursued two of the savages, and wounded them both; but as he was not able to
run, they both got from him into the wood, where Friday pursued them, and
killed one of them, but the other was too nimble for him; and though he was
wounded, yet had plunged himself into the sea, and swam with all his might off
to those two who were left in the canoe; which three in the canoe, with one
wounded, that we knew not whether he died or no, were all that escaped our
hands of one-and-twenty. The account of the whole is as follows: Three killed
at our first shot from the tree; two killed at the next shot; two killed by
Friday in the boat; two killed by Friday of those at first wounded; one killed
by Friday in the wood; three killed by the Spaniard; four killed, being found
dropped here and there, of the wounds, or killed by Friday in his chase of
them; four escaped in the boat, whereof one wounded, if not dead—twenty-one in
all.
Those that were in the canoe worked hard
to get out of gun-shot, and though Friday made two or three shots at them, I
did not find that he hit any of them. Friday would fain have had me take one of
their canoes, and pursue them; and indeed I was very anxious about their
escape, lest, carrying the news home to their people, they should come back
perhaps with two or three hundred of the canoes and devour us by mere multitude;
so I consented to pursue them by sea, and running to one of their canoes, I
jumped in and bade Friday follow me: but when I was in the canoe I was
surprised to find another poor creature lie there, bound hand and foot, as the
Spaniard was, for the slaughter, and almost dead with fear, not knowing what
was the matter; for he had not been able to look up over the side of the boat,
he was tied so hard neck and heels, and had been tied so long that he had
really but little life in him.
I immediately cut the twisted flags or
rushes which they had bound him with, and would have helped him up; but he
could not stand or speak, but groaned most piteously, believing, it seems,
still, that he was only unbound in order to be killed. When Friday came to him
I bade him speak to him, and tell him of his deliverance; and pulling out my
bottle, made him give the poor wretch a dram, which, with the news of his being
delivered, revived him, and he sat up in the boat. But when Friday came to hear
him speak, and look in his face, it would have moved any one to tears to have
seen how Friday kissed him, embraced him, hugged him, cried, laughed, hallooed,
jumped about, danced, sang; then cried again, wrung his hands, beat his own
face and head; and then sang and jumped about again like a distracted creature.
It was a good while before I could make him speak to me or tell me what was the
matter; but when he came a little to himself he told me that it was his father.
It is not easy for me to express how it
moved me to see what ecstasy and filial affection had worked in this poor
savage at the sight of his father, and of his being delivered from death; nor
indeed can I describe half the extravagances of his affection after this: for
he went into the boat and out of the boat a great many times: when he went in
to him he would sit down by him, open his breast, and hold his father’s head
close to his bosom for many minutes together, to nourish it; then he took his
arms and ankles, which were numbed and stiff with the binding, and chafed and
rubbed them with his hands; and I, perceiving what the case was, gave him some
rum out of my bottle to rub them with, which did them a great deal of good.
This affair put an end to our pursuit of
the canoe with the other savages, who were now almost out of sight; and it was
happy for us that we did not, for it blew so hard within two hours after, and
before they could be got a quarter of their way, and continued blowing so hard
all night, and that from the north-west, which was against them, that I could
not suppose their boat could live, or that they ever reached their own coast.
But to return to Friday; he was so busy
about his father that I could not find in my heart to take him off for some
time; but after I thought he could leave him a little, I called him to me, and
he came jumping and laughing, and pleased to the highest extreme: then I asked
him if he had given his father any bread. He shook his head, and said, “None;
ugly dog eat all up self.” I then gave him a cake of bread out of a little pouch
I carried on purpose; I also gave him a dram for himself; but he would not
taste it, but carried it to his father. I had in my pocket two or three bunches
of raisins, so I gave him a handful of them for his father. He had no sooner
given his father these raisins but I saw him come out of the boat, and run away
as if he had been bewitched, for he was the swiftest fellow on his feet that
ever I saw: I say, he ran at such a rate that he was out of sight, as it were,
in an instant; and though I called, and hallooed out too after him, it was all
one—away he went; and in a quarter of an hour I saw him come back again, though
not so fast as he went; and as he came nearer I found his pace slacker, because
he had something in his hand. When he came up to me I found he had been quite
home for an earthen jug or pot, to bring his father some fresh water, and that
he had got two more cakes or loaves of bread: the bread he gave me, but the
water he carried to his father; however, as I was very thirsty too, I took a little
of it. The water revived his father more than all the rum or spirits I had
given him, for he was fainting with thirst.
When his father had drunk, I called to him
to know if there was any water left. He said, “Yes”; and I bade him give it to
the poor Spaniard, who was in as much want of it as his father; and I sent one
of the cakes that Friday brought to the Spaniard too, who was indeed very weak,
and was reposing himself upon a green place under the shade of a tree; and
whose limbs were also very stiff, and very much swelled with the rude bandage
he had been tied with. When I saw that upon Friday’s coming to him with the
water he sat up and drank, and took the bread and began to eat, I went to him
and gave him a handful of raisins. He looked up in my face with all the tokens
of gratitude and thankfulness that could appear in any countenance; but was so
weak, notwithstanding he had so exerted himself in the fight, that he could not
stand up upon his feet—he tried to do it two or three times, but was really not
able, his ankles were so swelled and so painful to him; so I bade him sit
still, and caused Friday to rub his ankles, and bathe them with rum, as he had
done his father’s.
I observed the poor affectionate creature,
every two minutes, or perhaps less, all the while he was here, turn his head
about to see if his father was in the same place and posture as he left him
sitting; and at last he found he was not to be seen; at which he started up,
and, without speaking a word, flew with that swiftness to him that one could
scarce perceive his feet to touch the ground as he went; but when he came, he
only found he had laid himself down to ease his limbs, so Friday came back to
me presently; and then I spoke to the Spaniard to let Friday help him up if he
could, and lead him to the boat, and then he should carry him to our dwelling,
where I would take care of him. But Friday, a lusty, strong fellow, took the
Spaniard upon his back, and carried him away to the boat, and set him down
softly upon the side or gunnel of the canoe, with his feet in the inside of it;
and then lifting him quite in, he set him close to his father; and presently
stepping out again, launched the boat off, and paddled it along the shore
faster than I could walk, though the wind blew pretty hard too; so he brought
them both safe into our creek, and leaving them in the boat, ran away to fetch
the other canoe. As he passed me I spoke to him, and asked him whither he went.
He told me, “Go fetch more boat;” so away he went like the wind, for sure never
man or horse ran like him; and he had the other canoe in the creek almost as
soon as I got to it by land; so he wafted me over, and then went to help our
new guests out of the boat, which he did; but they were neither of them able to
walk; so that poor Friday knew not what to do.
To remedy this, I went to work in my
thought, and calling to Friday to bid them sit down on the bank while he came
to me, I soon made a kind of hand-barrow to lay them on, and Friday and I
carried them both up together upon it between us.
But when we got them to the outside of our
wall, or fortification, we were at a worse loss than before, for it was
impossible to get them over, and I was resolved not to break it down; so I set
to work again, and Friday and I, in about two hours’ time, made a very handsome
tent, covered with old sails, and above that with boughs of trees, being in the
space without our outward fence and between that and the grove of young wood
which I had planted; and here we made them two beds of such things as I
had—viz. of good rice-straw, with blankets laid upon it to lie on, and another
to cover them, on each bed.
My island was now peopled, and I thought
myself very rich in subjects; and it was a merry reflection, which I frequently
made, how like a king I looked. First of all, the whole country was my own
property, so that I had an undoubted right of dominion. Secondly, my people
were perfectly subjected—I was absolutely lord and lawgiver—they all owed their
lives to me, and were ready to lay down their lives, if there had been occasion
for it, for me. It was remarkable, too, I had but three subjects, and they were
of three different religions—my man Friday was a Protestant, his father was a
Pagan and a cannibal, and the Spaniard was a Papist. However, I allowed liberty
of conscience throughout my dominions. But this is by the way.
As soon as I had secured my two weak,
rescued prisoners, and given them shelter, and a place to rest them upon, I
began to think of making some provision for them; and the first thing I did, I
ordered Friday to take a yearling goat, betwixt a kid and a goat, out of my
particular flock, to be killed; when I cut off the hinder-quarter, and chopping
it into small pieces, I set Friday to work to boiling and stewing, and made
them a very good dish, I assure you, of flesh and broth; and as I cooked it
without doors, for I made no fire within my inner wall, so I carried it all
into the new tent, and having set a table there for them, I sat down, and ate
my own dinner also with them, and, as well as I could, cheered them and
encouraged them. Friday was my interpreter, especially to his father, and,
indeed, to the Spaniard too; for the Spaniard spoke the language of the savages
pretty well.
After we had dined, or rather supped, I
ordered Friday to take one of the canoes, and go and fetch our muskets and
other firearms, which, for want of time, we had left upon the place of battle;
and the next day I ordered him to go and bury the dead bodies of the savages,
which lay open to the sun, and would presently be offensive. I also ordered him
to bury the horrid remains of their barbarous feast, which I could not think of
doing myself; nay, I could not bear to see them if I went that way; all which
he punctually performed, and effaced the very appearance of the savages being
there; so that when I went again, I could scarce know where it was, otherwise
than by the corner of the wood pointing to the place.
I then began to enter into a little
conversation with my two new subjects; and, first, I set Friday to inquire of
his father what he thought of the escape of the savages in that canoe, and
whether we might expect a return of them, with a power too great for us to
resist. His first opinion was, that the savages in the boat never could live
out the storm which blew that night they went off, but must of necessity be
drowned, or driven south to those other shores, where they were as sure to be
devoured as they were to be drowned if they were cast away; but, as to what
they would do if they came safe on shore, he said he knew not; but it was his
opinion that they were so dreadfully frightened with the manner of their being
attacked, the noise, and the fire, that he believed they would tell the people
they were all killed by thunder and lightning, not by the hand of man; and that
the two which appeared—viz. Friday and I—were two heavenly spirits, or furies,
come down to destroy them, and not men with weapons. This, he said, he knew;
because he heard them all cry out so, in their language, one to another; for it
was impossible for them to conceive that a man could dart fire, and speak
thunder, and kill at a distance, without lifting up the hand, as was done now:
and this old savage was in the right; for, as I understood since, by other
hands, the savages never attempted to go over to the island afterwards, they
were so terrified with the accounts given by those four men (for it seems they
did escape the sea), that they believed whoever went to that enchanted island
would be destroyed with fire from the gods. This, however, I knew not; and
therefore was under continual apprehensions for a good while, and kept always
upon my guard, with all my army: for, as there were now four of us, I would
have ventured upon a hundred of them, fairly in the open field, at any time.
3/17-a
Thursday-RC-Ch. 16 2nd 1/2 of 20 (see 3/14- a Monday- 4 Ch. 16 1st 1/2)=
1q How many men did "Friday kill"?
Answer="2"
2q How many men did "Friday wound"?
Answer= "3 more"
3q What were "Friday and I"?
Answer= "2 furies"
4q How many of them were there?
Answer= "4 of us"
5q How many of them were there?
Answer= "a 100 of them."
BQ How did Friday "go & fetch our muskets and other firearms"?
Answer= By
"canoe"
3/18
CHAPTER XVII.
VISIT OF MUTINEERS
In a little time, however, no more canoes
appearing, the fear of their coming wore off; and I began to take my former
thoughts of a voyage to the main into consideration; being likewise assured by
Friday’s father that I might depend upon good usage from their nation, on his
account, if I would go. But my thoughts were a little suspended when I had a
serious discourse with the Spaniard, and when I understood that there were
sixteen more of his countrymen and Portuguese, who having been cast away and
made their escape to that side, lived there at peace, indeed, with the savages,
but were very sore put to it for necessaries, and, indeed, for life. I asked
him all the particulars of their voyage, and found they were a Spanish ship,
bound from the Rio de la Plata to the Havanna, being directed to leave their
loading there, which was chiefly hides and silver, and to bring back what
European goods they could meet with there; that they had five Portuguese seamen
on board, whom they took out of another wreck; that five of their own men were
drowned when first the ship was lost, and that these escaped through infinite
dangers and hazards, and arrived, almost starved, on the cannibal coast, where
they expected to have been devoured every moment. He told me they had some arms
with them, but they were perfectly useless, for that they had neither powder
nor ball, the washing of the sea having spoiled all their powder but a little,
which they used at their first landing to provide themselves with some food.
I asked him what he thought would become
of them there, and if they had formed any design of making their escape. He
said they had many consultations about it; but that having neither vessel nor
tools to build one, nor provisions of any kind, their councils always ended in tears
and despair. I asked him how he thought they would receive a proposal from me,
which might tend towards an escape; and whether, if they were all here, it
might not be done. I told him with freedom, I feared mostly their treachery and
ill-usage of me, if I put my life in their hands; for that gratitude was no
inherent virtue in the nature of man, nor did men always square their dealings
by the obligations they had received so much as they did by the advantages they
expected. I told him it would be very hard that I should be made the instrument
of their deliverance, and that they should afterwards make me their prisoner in
New Spain, where an Englishman was certain to be made a sacrifice, what
necessity or what accident soever brought him thither; and that I had rather be
delivered up to the savages, and be devoured alive, than fall into the
merciless claws of the priests, and be carried into the Inquisition. I added
that, otherwise, I was persuaded, if they were all here, we might, with so many
hands, build a barque large enough to carry us all away, either to the Brazils
southward, or to the islands or Spanish coast northward; but that if, in
requital, they should, when I had put weapons into their hands, carry me by
force among their own people, I might be ill-used for my kindness to them, and
make my case worse than it was before.
He answered, with a great deal of candour
and ingenuousness, that their condition was so miserable, and that they were so
sensible of it, that he believed they would abhor the thought of using any man
unkindly that should contribute to their deliverance; and that, if I pleased,
he would go to them with the old man, and discourse with them about it, and
return again and bring me their answer; that he would make conditions with them
upon their solemn oath, that they should be absolutely under my direction as
their commander and captain; and they should swear upon the holy sacraments and
gospel to be true to me, and go to such Christian country as I should agree to,
and no other; and to be directed wholly and absolutely by my orders till they
were landed safely in such country as I intended, and that he would bring a
contract from them, under their hands, for that purpose. Then he told me he
would first swear to me himself that he would never stir from me as long as he
lived till I gave him orders; and that he would take my side to the last drop
of his blood, if there should happen the least breach of faith among his
countrymen. He told me they were all of them very civil, honest men, and they
were under the greatest distress imaginable, having neither weapons nor
clothes, nor any food, but at the mercy and discretion of the savages; out of
all hopes of ever returning to their own country; and that he was sure, if I
would undertake their relief, they would live and die by me.
Upon these assurances, I resolved to
venture to relieve them, if possible, and to send the old savage and this
Spaniard over to them to treat. But when we had got all things in readiness to
go, the Spaniard himself started an objection, which had so much prudence in it
on one hand, and so much sincerity on the other hand, that I could not but be
very well satisfied in it; and, by his advice, put off the deliverance of his
comrades for at least half a year. The case was thus: he had been with us now
about a month, during which time I had let him see in what manner I had
provided, with the assistance of Providence, for my support; and he saw
evidently what stock of corn and rice I had laid up; which, though it was more
than sufficient for myself, yet it was not sufficient, without good husbandry,
for my family, now it was increased to four; but much less would it be
sufficient if his countrymen, who were, as he said, sixteen, still alive,
should come over; and least of all would it be sufficient to victual our
vessel, if we should build one, for a voyage to any of the Christian colonies
of America; so he told me he thought it would be more advisable to let him and
the other two dig and cultivate some more land, as much as I could spare seed
to sow, and that we should wait another harvest, that we might have a supply of
corn for his countrymen, when they should come; for want might be a temptation
to them to disagree, or not to think themselves delivered, otherwise than out
of one difficulty into another. “You know,” says he, “the children of Israel,
though they rejoiced at first for their being delivered out of Egypt, yet
rebelled even against God Himself, that delivered them, when they came to want
bread in the wilderness.”
His caution was so seasonable, and his
advice so good, that I could not but be very well pleased with his proposal, as
well as I was satisfied with his fidelity; so we fell to digging, all four of
us, as well as the wooden tools we were furnished with permitted; and in about
a month’s time, by the end of which it was seed-time, we had got as much land
cured and trimmed up as we sowed two-and-twenty bushels of barley on, and
sixteen jars of rice, which was, in short, all the seed we had to spare: indeed,
we left ourselves barely sufficient, for our own food for the six months that
we had to expect our crop; that is to say reckoning from the time we set our
seed aside for sowing; for it is not to be supposed it is six months in the
ground in that country.
Having now society enough, and our numbers
being sufficient to put us out of fear of the savages, if they had come, unless
their number had been very great, we went freely all over the island, whenever
we found occasion; and as we had our escape or deliverance upon our thoughts,
it was impossible, at least for me, to have the means of it out of mine. For
this purpose I marked out several trees, which I thought fit for our work, and
I set Friday and his father to cut them down; and then I caused the Spaniard,
to whom I imparted my thoughts on that affair, to oversee and direct their
work. I showed them with what indefatigable pains I had hewed a large tree into
single planks, and I caused them to do the like, till they made about a dozen
large planks, of good oak, near two feet broad, thirty-five feet long, and from
two inches to four inches thick: what prodigious labour it took up any one may
imagine.
At the same time I contrived to increase
my little flock of tame goats as much as I could; and for this purpose I made
Friday and the Spaniard go out one day, and myself with Friday the next day
(for we took our turns), and by this means we got about twenty young kids to
breed up with the rest; for whenever we shot the dam, we saved the kids, and
added them to our flock. But above all, the season for curing the grapes coming
on, I caused such a prodigious quantity to be hung up in the sun, that, I
believe, had we been at Alicant, where the raisins of the sun are cured, we
could have filled sixty or eighty barrels; and these, with our bread, formed a
great part of our food—very good living too, I assure you, for they are
exceedingly nourishing.
It was now harvest, and our crop in good
order: it was not the most plentiful increase I had seen in the island, but,
however, it was enough to answer our end; for from twenty-two bushels of barley
we brought in and thrashed out above two hundred and twenty bushels; and the
like in proportion of the rice; which was store enough for our food to the next
harvest, though all the sixteen Spaniards had been on shore with me; or, if we
had been ready for a voyage, it would very plentifully have victualled our ship
to have carried us to any part of the world; that is to say, any part of
America. When we had thus housed and secured our magazine of corn, we fell to
work to make more wicker-ware, viz. great baskets, in which we kept it; and the
Spaniard was very handy and dexterous at this part, and often blamed me that I
did not make some things for defence of this kind of work; but I saw no need of
it.
And now, having a full supply of food for
all the guests I expected, I gave the Spaniard leave to go over to the main, to
see what he could do with those he had left behind him there. I gave him a
strict charge not to bring any man who would not first swear in the presence of
himself and the old savage that he would in no way injure, fight with, or
attack the person he should find in the island, who was so kind as to send for
them in order to their deliverance; but that they would stand by him and defend
him against all such attempts, and wherever they went would be entirely under
and subjected to his command; and that this should be put in writing, and
signed in their hands. How they were to have done this, when I knew they had
neither pen nor ink, was a question which we never asked. Under these
instructions, the Spaniard and the old savage, the father of Friday, went away
in one of the canoes which they might be said to have come in, or rather were
brought in, when they came as prisoners to be devoured by the savages. I gave
each of them a musket, with a firelock on it, and about eight charges of powder
and ball, charging them to be very good husbands of both, and not to use either
of them but upon urgent occasions.
This was a cheerful work, being the first
measures used by me in view of my deliverance for now twenty-seven years and
some days. I gave them provisions of bread and of dried grapes, sufficient for
themselves for many days, and sufficient for all the Spaniards—for about eight
days’ time; and wishing them a good voyage, I saw them go, agreeing with them
about a signal they should hang out at their return, by which I should know
them again when they came back, at a distance, before they came on shore. They
went away with a fair gale on the day that the moon was at full, by my account
in the month of October; but as for an exact reckoning of days, after I had
once lost it I could never recover it again; nor had I kept even the number of
years so punctually as to be sure I was right; though, as it proved when I
afterwards examined my account, I found I had kept a true reckoning of years.
It was no less than eight days I had
waited for them, when a strange and unforeseen accident intervened, of which
the like has not, perhaps, been heard of in history. I was fast asleep in my
hutch one morning, when my man Friday came running in to me, and called aloud,
“Master, master, they are come, they are come!” I jumped up, and regardless of
danger I went, as soon as I could get my clothes on, through my little grove,
which, by the way, was by this time grown to be a very thick wood; I say,
regardless of danger I went without my arms, which was not my custom to do; but
I was surprised when, turning my eyes to the sea, I presently saw a boat at
about a league and a half distance, standing in for the shore, with a
shoulder-of-mutton sail, as they call it, and the wind blowing pretty fair to
bring them in: also I observed, presently, that they did not come from that
side which the shore lay on, but from the southernmost end of the island. Upon
this I called Friday in, and bade him lie close, for these were not the people
we looked for, and that we might not know yet whether they were friends or
enemies. In the next place I went in to fetch my perspective glass to see what
I could make of them; and having taken the ladder out, I climbed up to the top
of the hill, as I used to do when I was apprehensive of anything, and to take
my view the plainer without being discovered. I had scarce set my foot upon the
hill when my eye plainly discovered a ship lying at anchor, at about two
leagues and a half distance from me, SSE., but not above a league and a half
from the shore. By my observation it appeared plainly to be an English ship,
and the boat appeared to be an English long-boat.
I cannot express the confusion I was in,
though the joy of seeing a ship, and one that I had reason to believe was
manned by my own countrymen, and consequently friends, was such as I cannot
describe; but yet I had some secret doubts hung about me—I cannot tell from
whence they came—bidding me keep upon my guard. In the first place, it occurred
to me to consider what business an English ship could have in that part of the
world, since it was not the way to or from any part of the world where the
English had any traffic; and I knew there had been no storms to drive them in
there in distress; and that if they were really English it was most probable
that they were here upon no good design; and that I had better continue as I
was than fall into the hands of thieves and murderers.
Let no man despise the secret hints and
notices of danger which sometimes are given him when he may think there is no
possibility of its being real. That such hints and notices are given us I
believe few that have made any observation of things can deny; that they are
certain discoveries of an invisible world, and a converse of spirits, we cannot
doubt; and if the tendency of them seems to be to warn us of danger, why should
we not suppose they are from some friendly agent (whether supreme, or inferior
and subordinate, is not the question), and that they are given for our good?
The present question abundantly confirms
me in the justice of this reasoning; for had I not been made cautious by this
secret admonition, come it from whence it will, I had been done inevitably, and
in a far worse condition than before, as you will see presently. I had not kept
myself long in this posture till I saw the boat draw near the shore, as if they
looked for a creek to thrust in at, for the convenience of landing; however, as
they did not come quite far enough, they did not see the little inlet where I
formerly landed my rafts, but ran their boat on shore upon the beach, at about
half a mile from me, which was very happy for me; for otherwise they would have
landed just at my door, as I may say, and would soon have beaten me out of my
castle, and perhaps have plundered me of all I had. When they were on shore I
was fully satisfied they were Englishmen, at least most of them; one or two I thought
were Dutch, but it did not prove so; there were in all eleven men, whereof
three of them I found were unarmed and, as I thought, bound; and when the first
four or five of them were jumped on shore, they took those three out of the
boat as prisoners: one of the three I could perceive using the most passionate
gestures of entreaty, affliction, and despair, even to a kind of extravagance;
the other two, I could perceive, lifted up their hands sometimes, and appeared
concerned indeed, but not to such a degree as the first. I was perfectly
confounded at the sight, and knew not what the meaning of it should be. Friday
called out to me in English, as well as he could, “O master! you see English
mans eat prisoner as well as savage mans.” “Why, Friday,” says I, “do you think
they are going to eat them, then?” “Yes,” says Friday, “they will eat them.”
“No no,” says I, “Friday; I am afraid they will murder them, indeed; but you
may be sure they will not eat them.”
3/18-a Friday-RC-Ch.
17 (see 3/15-a Tuesday-4 it) of 20=recreated below 4 ease=
1q "Visit of _______" Who?
Answer= "Mutineers"
2q How many "straggling men" were there?
Answer=3
3q What "affected" Friday "deeply"?
Answer= Robinson Crusoe's whole
history
4q How long had his "grove of trees" been planted there?
Answer= nearly 20
years
5q How many hands on board were there?
Answer= 26 (13 men)
BQ BQ How much was sugar?
Answer= 5 or 6 UK pounds= US $1.37 x 5 or 6= $6.85 or $8.22.
3/21
All
this while I had no thought of what the matter really was, but stood trembling
with the horror of the sight, expecting every moment when the three prisoners
should be killed; nay, once I saw one of the villains lift up his arm with a great cutlass, as
the seamen call it, or sword, to strike one of the poor men; and I expected to
see him fall every moment; at which all the blood in my body seemed to run
chill in my veins. I wished heartily now for the Spaniard, and the savage that
had gone with him, or that I had any way to have come undiscovered within shot
of them, that I might have secured the three men, for I saw no firearms they
had among them; but it fell out to my mind another way. After I had observed
the outrageous usage of the three men by the insolent seamen, I observed the
fellows run scattering about the island, as if they wanted to see the country.
I observed that the three other men had liberty to go also where they pleased;
but they sat down all three upon the ground, very pensive, and looked like men
in despair. This put me in mind of the first time when I came on shore, and
began to look about me; how I gave myself over for lost; how wildly I looked
round me; what dreadful apprehensions I had; and how I lodged in the tree all
night for fear of being devoured by wild beasts. As I knew nothing that night of
the supply I was to receive by the providential driving of the ship nearer the
land by the storms and tide, by which I have since been so long nourished and
supported; so these three poor desolate men knew nothing how certain of
deliverance and supply they were, how near it was to them, and how effectually
and really they were in a condition of safety, at the same time that they
thought themselves lost and their case desperate. So little do we see before us
in the world, and so much reason have we to depend cheerfully upon the great
Maker of the world, that He does not leave His creatures so absolutely
destitute, but that in the worst circumstances they have always something to be
thankful for, and sometimes are nearer deliverance than they imagine; nay, are
even brought to their deliverance by the means by which they seem to be brought
to their destruction.
It was just at high-water when these
people came on shore; and while they rambled about to see what kind of a place
they were in, they had carelessly stayed till the tide was spent, and the water
was ebbed considerably away, leaving their boat aground. They had left two men
in the boat, who, as I found afterwards, having drunk a little too much brandy,
fell asleep; however, one of them waking a little sooner than the other and
finding the boat too fast aground for him to stir it, hallooed out for the
rest, who were straggling about: upon which they all soon came to the boat: but
it was past all their strength to launch her, the boat being very heavy, and the
shore on that side being a soft oozy sand, almost like a quicksand. In this
condition, like true seamen, who are, perhaps, the least of all mankind given
to forethought, they gave it over, and away they strolled about the country
again; and I heard one of them say aloud to another, calling them off from the
boat, “Why, let her alone, Jack, can’t you? she’ll float next tide;” by which I
was fully confirmed in the main inquiry of what countrymen they were. All this
while I kept myself very close, not once daring to stir out of my castle any
farther than to my place of observation near the top of the hill: and very glad
I was to think how well it was fortified. I knew it was no less than ten hours
before the boat could float again, and by that time it would be dark, and I
might be at more liberty to see their motions, and to hear their discourse, if
they had any. In the meantime I fitted myself up for a battle as before, though
with more caution, knowing I had to do with another kind of enemy than I had at
first. I ordered Friday also, whom I had made an excellent marksman with his
gun, to load himself with arms. I took myself two fowling-pieces, and I gave
him three muskets. My figure, indeed, was very fierce; I had my formidable
goat-skin coat on, with the great cap I have mentioned, a naked sword by my
side, two pistols in my belt, and a gun upon each shoulder.
It was my design, as I said above, not to
have made any attempt till it was dark; but about two o’clock, being the heat
of the day, I found that they were all gone straggling into the woods, and, as
I thought, laid down to sleep. The three poor distressed men, too anxious for
their condition to get any sleep, had, however, sat down under the shelter of a
great tree, at about a quarter of a mile from me, and, as I thought, out of
sight of any of the rest. Upon this I resolved to discover myself to them, and
learn something of their condition; immediately I marched as above, my man
Friday at a good distance behind me, as formidable for his arms as I, but not
making quite so staring a spectre-like figure as I did. I came as near them
undiscovered as I could, and then, before any of them saw me, I called aloud to
them in Spanish, “What are ye, gentlemen?” They started up at the noise, but
were ten times more confounded when they saw me, and the uncouth figure that I
made. They made no answer at all, but I thought I perceived them just going to
fly from me, when I spoke to them in English. “Gentlemen,” said I, “do not be
surprised at me; perhaps you may have a friend near when you did not expect
it.” “He must be sent directly from heaven then,” said one of them very gravely
to me, and pulling off his hat at the same time to me; “for our condition is
past the help of man.” “All help is from heaven, sir,” said I, “but can you put
a stranger in the way to help you? for you seem to be in some great distress. I
saw you when you landed; and when you seemed to make application to the brutes
that came with you, I saw one of them lift up his sword to kill you.”
The poor man, with tears running down his
face, and trembling, looking like one astonished, returned, “Am I talking to
God or man? Is it a real man or an angel?” “Be in no fear about that, sir,”
said I; “if God had sent an angel to relieve you, he would have come better
clothed, and armed after another manner than you see me; pray lay aside your
fears; I am a man, an Englishman, and disposed to assist you; you see I have
one servant only; we have arms and ammunition; tell us freely, can we serve
you? What is your case?” “Our case, sir,” said he, “is too long to tell you
while our murderers are so near us; but, in short, sir, I was commander of that
ship—my men have mutinied against me; they have been hardly prevailed on not to
murder me, and, at last, have set me on shore in this desolate place, with
these two men with me—one my mate, the other a passenger—where we expected to
perish, believing the place to be uninhabited, and know not yet what to think
of it.” “Where are these brutes, your enemies?” said I; “do you know where they
are gone?” “There they lie, sir,” said he, pointing to a thicket of trees; “my
heart trembles for fear they have seen us and heard you speak; if they have,
they will certainly murder us all.” “Have they any firearms?” said I. He
answered, “They had only two pieces, one of which they left in the boat.”
“Well, then,” said I, “leave the rest to me; I see they are all asleep; it is
an easy thing to kill them all; but shall we rather take them prisoners?” He
told me there were two desperate villains among them that it was scarce safe to
show any mercy to; but if they were secured, he believed all the rest would
return to their duty. I asked him which they were. He told me he could not at
that distance distinguish them, but he would obey my orders in anything I would
direct. “Well,” says I, “let us retreat out of their view or hearing, lest they
awake, and we will resolve further.” So they willingly went back with me, till
the woods covered us from them.
“Look you, sir,” said I, “if I venture
upon your deliverance, are you willing to make two conditions with me?” He
anticipated my proposals by telling me that both he and the ship, if recovered,
should be wholly directed and commanded by me in everything; and if the ship
was not recovered, he would live and die with me in what part of the world
soever I would send him; and the two other men said the same. “Well,” says I,
“my conditions are but two; first, that while you stay in this island with me,
you will not pretend to any authority here; and if I put arms in your hands,
you will, upon all occasions, give them up to me, and do no prejudice to me or
mine upon this island, and in the meantime be governed by my orders; secondly,
that if the ship is or may be recovered, you will carry me and my man to England
passage free.”
He gave me all the assurances that the
invention or faith of man could devise that he would comply with these most
reasonable demands, and besides would owe his life to me, and acknowledge it
upon all occasions as long as he lived. “Well, then,” said I, “here are three
muskets for you, with powder and ball; tell me next what you think is proper to
be done.” He showed all the testimonies of his gratitude that he was able, but
offered to be wholly guided by me. I told him I thought it was very hard
venturing anything; but the best method I could think of was to fire on them at
once as they lay, and if any were not killed at the first volley, and offered
to submit, we might save them, and so put it wholly upon God’s providence to
direct the shot. He said, very modestly, that he was loath to kill them if he
could help it; but that those two were incorrigible villains, and had been the
authors of all the mutiny in the ship, and if they escaped, we should be undone
still, for they would go on board and bring the whole ship’s company, and
destroy us all. “Well, then,” says I, “necessity legitimates my advice, for it
is the only way to save our lives.” However, seeing him still cautious of
shedding blood, I told him they should go themselves, and manage as they found
convenient.
In the middle of this discourse we heard
some of them awake, and soon after we saw two of them on their feet. I asked
him if either of them were the heads of the mutiny? He said, “No.” “Well,
then,” said I, “you may let them escape; and Providence seems to have awakened
them on purpose to save themselves. Now,” says I, “if the rest escape you, it
is your fault.” Animated with this, he took the musket I had given him in his
hand, and a pistol in his belt, and his two comrades with him, with each a
piece in his hand; the two men who were with him going first made some noise,
at which one of the seamen who was awake turned about, and seeing them coming,
cried out to the rest; but was too late then, for the moment he cried out they
fired—I mean the two men, the captain wisely reserving his own piece. They had
so well aimed their shot at the men they knew, that one of them was killed on
the spot, and the other very much wounded; but not being dead, he started up on
his feet, and called eagerly for help to the other; but the captain stepping to
him, told him it was too late to cry for help, he should call upon God to
forgive his villainy, and with that word knocked him down with the stock of his
musket, so that he never spoke more; there were three more in the company, and
one of them was slightly wounded. By this time I was come; and when they saw
their danger, and that it was in vain to resist, they begged for mercy. The
captain told them he would spare their lives if they would give him an
assurance of their abhorrence of the treachery they had been guilty of, and
would swear to be faithful to him in recovering the ship, and afterwards in
carrying her back to Jamaica, from whence they came. They gave him all the
protestations of their sincerity that could be desired; and he was willing to
believe them, and spare their lives, which I was not against, only that I
obliged him to keep them bound hand and foot while they were on the island.
While this was doing, I sent Friday with
the captain’s mate to the boat with orders to secure her, and bring away the
oars and sails, which they did; and by-and-by three straggling men, that were
(happily for them) parted from the rest, came back upon hearing the guns fired;
and seeing the captain, who was before their prisoner, now their conqueror,
they submitted to be bound also; and so our victory was complete.
It now remained that the captain and I
should inquire into one another’s circumstances. I began first, and told him my
whole history, which he heard with an attention even to amazement—and
particularly at the wonderful manner of my being furnished with provisions and
ammunition; and, indeed, as my story is a whole collection of wonders, it
affected him deeply. But when he reflected from thence upon himself, and how I
seemed to have been preserved there on purpose to save his life, the tears ran
down his face, and he could not speak a word more. After this communication was
at an end, I carried him and his two men into my apartment, leading them in
just where I came out, viz. at the top of the house, where I refreshed them
with such provisions as I had, and showed them all the contrivances I had made
during my long, long inhabiting that place.
All I showed them, all I said to them, was
perfectly amazing; but above all, the captain admired my fortification, and how
perfectly I had concealed my retreat with a grove of trees, which having been
now planted nearly twenty years, and the trees growing much faster than in
England, was become a little wood, so thick that it was impassable in any part
of it but at that one side where I had reserved my little winding passage into
it. I told him this was my castle and my residence, but that I had a seat in
the country, as most princes have, whither I could retreat upon occasion, and I
would show him that too another time; but at present our business was to
consider how to recover the ship. He agreed with me as to that, but told me he
was perfectly at a loss what measures to take, for that there were still six-and-twenty
hands on board, who, having entered into a cursed conspiracy, by which they had
all forfeited their lives to the law, would be hardened in it now by
desperation, and would carry it on, knowing that if they were subdued they
would be brought to the gallows as soon as they came to England, or to any of
the English colonies, and that, therefore, there would be no attacking them
with so small a number as we were.
I mused for some time on what he had said,
and found it was a very rational conclusion, and that therefore something was
to be resolved on speedily, as well to draw the men on board into some snare
for their surprise as to prevent their landing upon us, and destroying us. Upon
this, it presently occurred to me that in a little while the ship’s crew,
wondering what was become of their comrades and of the boat, would certainly
come on shore in their other boat to look for them, and that then, perhaps,
they might come armed, and be too strong for us: this he allowed to be
rational. Upon this, I told him the first thing we had to do was to stave the
boat which lay upon the beach, so that they might not carry her off, and taking
everything out of her, leave her so far useless as not to be fit to swim.
Accordingly, we went on board, took the arms which were left on board out of
her, and whatever else we found there—which was a bottle of brandy, and another
of rum, a few biscuit-cakes, a horn of powder, and a great lump of sugar in a
piece of canvas (the sugar was five or six pounds): all which was very welcome
to me, especially the brandy and sugar, of which I had had none left for many
years.
When we had carried all these things on
shore (the oars, mast, sail, and rudder of the boat were carried away before),
we knocked a great hole in her bottom, that if they had come strong enough to
master us, yet they could not carry off the boat. Indeed, it was not much in my
thoughts that we could be able to recover the ship; but my view was, that if
they went away without the boat, I did not much question to make her again fit
to carry as to the Leeward Islands, and call upon our friends the Spaniards in
my way, for I had them still in my thoughts.
3/21-a Monday-RC-Ch.
18 (see 3/16- a Wednesday-4 it) of 20=righted! & recreated below 4 ease=
1q What was "Recovered"/found?
Answer= "The Ship"
2q How many prisoners were "incorrigible"?
Answer=2
3q What would Robinson Crusoe "prepare" "that night"?
Answer his
"things"
4q What did he make ink with?
Answer= "charcoal and water"
5q 5q How many muskets (guns) were there?
Answer= 5
BQ How many swords?
Answer= 3
3/22
CHAPTER XVIII.
THE SHIP RECOVERED
While we were thus preparing our designs,
and had first, by main strength, heaved the boat upon the beach, so high that
the tide would not float her off at high-water mark, and besides, had broke a
hole in her bottom too big to be quickly stopped, and were set down musing what
we should do, we heard the ship fire a gun, and make a waft with her ensign as
a signal for the boat to come on board—but no boat stirred; and they fired
several times, making other signals for the boat. At last, when all their
signals and firing proved fruitless, and they found the boat did not stir, we
saw them, by the help of my glasses, hoist another boat out and row towards the
shore; and we found, as they approached, that there were no less than ten men
in her, and that they had firearms with them.
As the ship lay almost two leagues from
the shore, we had a full view of them as they came, and a plain sight even of
their faces; because the tide having set them a little to the east of the other
boat, they rowed up under shore, to come to the same place where the other had
landed, and where the boat lay; by this means, I say, we had a full view of
them, and the captain knew the persons and characters of all the men in the
boat, of whom, he said, there were three very honest fellows, who, he was sure,
were led into this conspiracy by the rest, being over-powered and frightened;
but that as for the boatswain, who it seems was the chief officer among them,
and all the rest, they were as outrageous as any of the ship’s crew, and were
no doubt made desperate in their new enterprise; and terribly apprehensive he
was that they would be too powerful for us. I smiled at him, and told him that
men in our circumstances were past the operation of fear; that seeing almost
every condition that could be was better than that which we were supposed to be
in, we ought to expect that the consequence, whether death or life, would be
sure to be a deliverance. I asked him what he thought of the circumstances of
my life, and whether a deliverance were not worth venturing for? “And where,
sir,” said I, “is your belief of my being preserved here on purpose to save
your life, which elevated you a little while ago? For my part,” said I, “there
seems to be but one thing amiss in all the prospect of it.” “What is that?” say
he. “Why,” said I, “it is, that as you say there are three or four honest
fellows among them which should be spared, had they been all of the wicked part
of the crew I should have thought God’s providence had singled them out to
deliver them into your hands; for depend upon it, every man that comes ashore
is our own, and shall die or live as they behave to us.” As I spoke this with a
raised voice and cheerful countenance, I found it greatly encouraged him; so we
set vigorously to our business.
We had, upon the first appearance of the
boat’s coming from the ship, considered of separating our prisoners; and we
had, indeed, secured them effectually. Two of them, of whom the captain was
less assured than ordinary, I sent with Friday, and one of the three delivered
men, to my cave, where they were remote enough, and out of danger of being
heard or discovered, or of finding their way out of the woods if they could
have delivered themselves. Here they left them bound, but gave them provisions;
and promised them, if they continued there quietly, to give them their liberty
in a day or two; but that if they attempted their escape they should be put to
death without mercy. They promised faithfully to bear their confinement with
patience, and were very thankful that they had such good usage as to have
provisions and light left them; for Friday gave them candles (such as we made
ourselves) for their comfort; and they did not know but that he stood sentinel
over them at the entrance.
The other prisoners had better usage; two
of them were kept pinioned, indeed, because the captain was not able to trust
them; but the other two were taken into my service, upon the captain’s
recommendation, and upon their solemnly engaging to live and die with us; so
with them and the three honest men we were seven men, well armed; and I made no
doubt we should be able to deal well enough with the ten that were coming, considering
that the captain had said there were three or four honest men among them also.
As soon as they got to the place where their other boat lay, they ran their
boat into the beach and came all on shore, hauling the boat up after them,
which I was glad to see, for I was afraid they would rather have left the boat
at an anchor some distance from the shore, with some hands in her to guard her,
and so we should not be able to seize the boat. Being on shore, the first thing
they did, they ran all to their other boat; and it was easy to see they were
under a great surprise to find her stripped, as above, of all that was in her,
and a great hole in her bottom. After they had mused a while upon this, they
set up two or three great shouts, hallooing with all their might, to try if
they could make their companions hear; but all was to no purpose. Then they
came all close in a ring, and fired a volley of their small arms, which indeed
we heard, and the echoes made the woods ring. But it was all one; those in the
cave, we were sure, could not hear; and those in our keeping, though they heard
it well enough, yet durst give no answer to them. They were so astonished at
the surprise of this, that, as they told us afterwards, they resolved to go all
on board again to their ship, and let them know that the men were all murdered,
and the long-boat staved; accordingly, they immediately launched their boat
again, and got all of them on board.
The captain was terribly amazed, and even
confounded, at this, believing they would go on board the ship again and set
sail, giving their comrades over for lost, and so he should still lose the
ship, which he was in hopes we should have recovered; but he was quickly as
much frightened the other way.
They had not been long put off with the boat,
when we perceived them all coming on shore again; but with this new measure in
their conduct, which it seems they consulted together upon, viz. to leave three
men in the boat, and the rest to go on shore, and go up into the country to
look for their fellows. This was a great disappointment to us, for now we were
at a loss what to do, as our seizing those seven men on shore would be no
advantage to us if we let the boat escape; because they would row away to the
ship, and then the rest of them would be sure to weigh and set sail, and so our
recovering the ship would be lost. However we had no remedy but to wait and see
what the issue of things might present. The seven men came on shore, and the
three who remained in the boat put her off to a good distance from the shore,
and came to an anchor to wait for them; so that it was impossible for us to
come at them in the boat. Those that came on shore kept close together,
marching towards the top of the little hill under which my habitation lay; and
we could see them plainly, though they could not perceive us. We should have
been very glad if they would have come nearer us, so that we might have fired
at them, or that they would have gone farther off, that we might come abroad.
But when they were come to the brow of the hill where they could see a great
way into the valleys and woods, which lay towards the north-east part, and
where the island lay lowest, they shouted and hallooed till they were weary;
and not caring, it seems, to venture far from the shore, nor far from one
another, they sat down together under a tree to consider it. Had they thought
fit to have gone to sleep there, as the other part of them had done, they had
done the job for us; but they were too full of apprehensions of danger to
venture to go to sleep, though they could not tell what the danger was they had
to fear.
The captain made a very just proposal to
me upon this consultation of theirs, viz. that perhaps they would all fire a
volley again, to endeavour to make their fellows hear, and that we should all
sally upon them just at the juncture when their pieces were all discharged, and
they would certainly yield, and we should have them without bloodshed. I liked
this proposal, provided it was done while we were near enough to come up to them
before they could load their pieces again. But this event did not happen; and
we lay still a long time, very irresolute what course to take. At length I told
them there would be nothing done, in my opinion, till night; and then, if they
did not return to the boat, perhaps we might find a way to get between them and
the shore, and so might use some stratagem with them in the boat to get them on
shore. We waited a great while, though very impatient for their removing; and
were very uneasy when, after long consultation, we saw them all start up and
march down towards the sea; it seems they had such dreadful apprehensions of
the danger of the place that they resolved to go on board the ship again, give
their companions over for lost, and so go on with their intended voyage with
the ship.
As soon as I perceived them go towards the
shore, I imagined it to be as it really was that they had given over their
search, and were going back again; and the captain, as soon as I told him my
thoughts, was ready to sink at the apprehensions of it; but I presently thought
of a stratagem to fetch them back again, and which answered my end to a tittle.
I ordered Friday and the captain’s mate to go over the little creek westward,
towards the place where the savages came on shore, when Friday was rescued, and
so soon as they came to a little rising round, at about half a mile distant, I
bid them halloo out, as loud as they could, and wait till they found the seamen
heard them; that as soon as ever they heard the seamen answer them, they should
return it again; and then, keeping out of sight, take a round, always answering
when the others hallooed, to draw them as far into the island and among the
woods as possible, and then wheel about again to me by such ways as I directed
them.
They were just going into the boat when
Friday and the mate hallooed; and they presently heard them, and answering, ran
along the shore westward, towards the voice they heard, when they were stopped
by the creek, where the water being up, they could not get over, and called for
the boat to come up and set them over; as, indeed, I expected. When they had
set themselves over, I observed that the boat being gone a good way into the
creek, and, as it were, in a harbour within the land, they took one of the
three men out of her, to go along with them, and left only two in the boat,
having fastened her to the stump of a little tree on the shore. This was what I
wished for; and immediately leaving Friday and the captain’s mate to their
business, I took the rest with me; and, crossing the creek out of their sight,
we surprised the two men before they were aware—one of them lying on the shore,
and the other being in the boat. The fellow on shore was between sleeping and
waking, and going to start up; the captain, who was foremost, ran in upon him,
and knocked him down; and then called out to him in the boat to yield, or he
was a dead man. They needed very few arguments to persuade a single man to
yield, when he saw five men upon him and his comrade knocked down: besides, this
was, it seems, one of the three who were not so hearty in the mutiny as the
rest of the crew, and therefore was easily persuaded not only to yield, but
afterwards to join very sincerely with us. In the meantime, Friday and the
captain’s mate so well managed their business with the rest that they drew
them, by hallooing and answering, from one hill to another, and from one wood
to another, till they not only heartily tired them, but left them where they
were, very sure they could not reach back to the boat before it was dark; and,
indeed, they were heartily tired themselves also, by the time they came back to
us.
We had nothing now to do but to watch for
them in the dark, and to fall upon them, so as to make sure work with them. It
was several hours after Friday came back to me before they came back to their
boat; and we could hear the foremost of them, long before they came quite up,
calling to those behind to come along; and could also hear them answer, and
complain how lame and tired they were, and not able to come any faster: which
was very welcome news to us. At length they came up to the boat: but it is
impossible to express their confusion when they found the boat fast aground in
the creek, the tide ebbed out, and their two men gone. We could hear them call
one to another in a most lamentable manner, telling one another they were got
into an enchanted island; that either there were inhabitants in it, and they
should all be murdered, or else there were devils and spirits in it, and they
should be all carried away and devoured. They hallooed again, and called their
two comrades by their names a great many times; but no answer. After some time
we could see them, by the little light there was, run about, wringing their
hands like men in despair, and sometimes they would go and sit down in the boat
to rest themselves: then come ashore again, and walk about again, and so the
same thing over again. My men would fain have had me give them leave to fall
upon them at once in the dark; but I was willing to take them at some
advantage, so as to spare them, and kill as few of them as I could; and
especially I was unwilling to hazard the killing of any of our men, knowing the
others were very well armed. I resolved to wait, to see if they did not
separate; and therefore, to make sure of them, I drew my ambuscade nearer, and
ordered Friday and the captain to creep upon their hands and feet, as close to
the ground as they could, that they might not be discovered, and get as near
them as they could possibly before they offered to fire.
They had not been long in that posture
when the boatswain, who was the principal ringleader of the mutiny, and had now
shown himself the most dejected and dispirited of all the rest, came walking
towards them, with two more of the crew; the captain was so eager at having
this principal rogue so much in his power, that he could hardly have patience
to let him come so near as to be sure of him, for they only heard his tongue
before: but when they came nearer, the captain and Friday, starting up on their
feet, let fly at them. The boatswain was killed upon the spot: the next man was
shot in the body, and fell just by him, though he did not die till an hour or
two after; and the third ran for it. At the noise of the fire I immediately
advanced with my whole army, which was now eight men, viz. myself,
generalissimo; Friday, my lieutenant-general; the captain and his two men, and
the three prisoners of war whom we had trusted with arms. We came upon them,
indeed, in the dark, so that they could not see our number; and I made the man
they had left in the boat, who was now one of us, to call them by name, to try
if I could bring them to a parley, and so perhaps might reduce them to terms;
which fell out just as we desired: for indeed it was easy to think, as their
condition then was, they would be very willing to capitulate. So he calls out
as loud as he could to one of them, “Tom Smith! Tom Smith!” Tom Smith answered
immediately, “Is that Robinson?” for it seems he knew the voice. The other
answered, “Ay, ay; for God’s sake, Tom Smith, throw down your arms and yield,
or you are all dead men this moment.” “Who must we yield to? Where are they?”
says Smith again. “Here they are,” says he; “here’s our captain and fifty men
with him, have been hunting you these two hours; the boatswain is killed; Will
Fry is wounded, and I am a prisoner; and if you do not yield you are all lost.”
“Will they give us quarter, then?” says Tom Smith, “and we will yield.” “I’ll
go and ask, if you promise to yield,” said Robinson: so he asked the captain,
and the captain himself then calls out, “You, Smith, you know my voice; if you
lay down your arms immediately and submit, you shall have your lives, all but
Will Atkins.”
Upon this Will Atkins cried out, “For
God’s sake, captain, give me quarter; what have I done? They have all been as
bad as I:” which, by the way, was not true; for it seems this Will Atkins was
the first man that laid hold of the captain when they first mutinied, and used
him barbarously in tying his hands and giving him injurious language. However,
the captain told him he must lay down his arms at discretion, and trust to the
governor’s mercy: by which he meant me, for they all called me governor. In a
word, they all laid down their arms and begged their lives; and I sent the man
that had parleyed with them, and two more, who bound them all; and then my
great army of fifty men, which, with those three, were in all but eight, came
up and seized upon them, and upon their boat; only that I kept myself and one
more out of sight for reasons of state.
Our next work was to repair the boat, and
think of seizing the ship: and as for the captain, now he had leisure to parley
with them, he expostulated with them upon the villainy of their practices with
him, and upon the further wickedness of their design, and how certainly it must
bring them to misery and distress in the end, and perhaps to the gallows. They
all appeared very penitent, and begged hard for their lives. As for that, he
told them they were not his prisoners, but the commander’s of the island; that
they thought they had set him on shore in a barren, uninhabited island; but it
had pleased God so to direct them that it was inhabited, and that the governor
was an Englishman; that he might hang them all there, if he pleased; but as he
had given them all quarter, he supposed he would send them to England, to be
dealt with there as justice required, except Atkins, whom he was commanded by
the governor to advise to prepare for death, for that he would be hanged in the
morning.
Though this was all but a fiction of his
own, yet it had its desired effect; Atkins fell upon his knees to beg the
captain to intercede with the governor for his life; and all the rest begged of
him, for God’s sake, that they might not be sent to England.
It now occurred to me that the time of our
deliverance was come, and that it would be a most easy thing to bring these
fellows in to be hearty in getting possession of the ship; so I retired in the
dark from them, that they might not see what kind of a governor they had, and
called the captain to me; when I called, at a good distance, one of the men was
ordered to speak again, and say to the captain, “Captain, the commander calls
for you;” and presently the captain replied, “Tell his excellency I am just
coming.” This more perfectly amazed them, and they all believed that the
commander was just by, with his fifty men. Upon the captain coming to me, I
told him my project for seizing the ship, which he liked wonderfully well, and
resolved to put it in execution the next morning. But, in order to execute it
with more art, and to be secure of success, I told him we must divide the
prisoners, and that he should go and take Atkins, and two more of the worst of
them, and send them pinioned to the cave where the others lay. This was
committed to Friday and the two men who came on shore with the captain. They
conveyed them to the cave as to a prison: and it was, indeed, a dismal place,
especially to men in their condition. The others I ordered to my bower, as I
called it, of which I have given a full description: and as it was fenced in,
and they pinioned, the place was secure enough, considering they were upon
their behaviour.
To these in the morning I sent the
captain, who was to enter into a parley with them; in a word, to try them, and
tell me whether he thought they might be trusted or not to go on board and
surprise the ship. He talked to them of the injury done him, of the condition
they were brought to, and that though the governor had given them quarter for
their lives as to the present action, yet that if they were sent to England
they would all be hanged in chains; but that if they would join in so just an
attempt as to recover the ship, he would have the governor’s engagement for
their pardon.
3/22 of Tuesday-RC-Ch.
19/or above/ of 20=
1q "Returning to_______" where?
Answer= "England."
2q How long was "the account"?
Answer= "4 years more"
3q Whose account was it?
Answer= "the Prior of St. Augustine" (Saint= St. not Street)
4q How long was "the Prior of St. Augustine"'s account?
Answer= "14
years +"
5q How many "moidores" were there?
Answer= "872" or a moidoire is
Portuguese money, 1 moidore= UK 27 shillings or 20 shillings= 1 UK pound so 872
x 27 shillings= 23,544 UK shillings divided by 20= UK pounds 1177.20 or US$
1,567.43.
BQ How many "cruscadoes" were there?
Answer= "19, 446" or Portuguese or
Brazilian (Cruzado) money again= currently, in Brazilian Real, = 19 Real= US $
3.42 or 19, 446 divided by 19= US $ 1, 023.47.
3/23
Any
one may guess how readily such a proposal would be accepted by men in their
condition; they fell down on their knees to the captain, and promised, with the
deepest imprecations, that they would be faithful to him to the last drop, and
that they should owe their lives to him, and would go with him all over the
world; that they would own him as a father to them as long as they lived.
“Well,” says the captain, “I must go and tell the governor what you say, and
see what I can do to bring him to consent to it.” So he brought me an account
of the temper he found them in, and that he verily believed they would be
faithful. However, that we might be very secure, I told him he should go back
again and choose out those five, and tell them, that they might see he did not
want men, that he would take
out those five to be his assistants, and that the governor would keep the other
two, and the three that were sent prisoners to the castle (my cave), as
hostages for the fidelity of those five; and that if they proved unfaithful in
the execution, the five hostages should be hanged in chains alive on the shore.
This looked severe, and convinced them that the governor was in earnest;
however, they had no way left them but to accept it; and it was now the
business of the prisoners, as much as of the captain, to persuade the other
five to do their duty.
Our strength was now thus ordered for the
expedition: first, the captain, his mate, and passenger; second, the two
prisoners of the first gang, to whom, having their character from the captain,
I had given their liberty, and trusted them with arms; third, the other two
that I had kept till now in my bower, pinioned, but on the captain’s motion had
now released; fourth, these five released at last; so that there were twelve in
all, besides five we kept prisoners in the cave for hostages.
I asked the captain if he was willing to
venture with these hands on board the ship; but as for me and my man Friday, I
did not think it was proper for us to stir, having seven men left behind; and
it was employment enough for us to keep them asunder, and supply them with
victuals. As to the five in the cave, I resolved to keep them fast, but Friday
went in twice a day to them, to supply them with necessaries; and I made the
other two carry provisions to a certain distance, where Friday was to take
them.
When I showed myself to the two hostages,
it was with the captain, who told them I was the person the governor had
ordered to look after them; and that it was the governor’s pleasure they should
not stir anywhere but by my direction; that if they did, they would be fetched
into the castle, and be laid in irons: so that as we never suffered them to see
me as governor, I now appeared as another person, and spoke of the governor,
the garrison, the castle, and the like, upon all occasions.
The captain now had no difficulty before
him, but to furnish his two boats, stop the breach of one, and man them. He
made his passenger captain of one, with four of the men; and himself, his mate,
and five more, went in the other; and they contrived their business very well,
for they came up to the ship about midnight. As soon as they came within call
of the ship, he made Robinson hail them, and tell them they had brought off the
men and the boat, but that it was a long time before they had found them, and
the like, holding them in a chat till they came to the ship’s side; when the
captain and the mate entering first with their arms, immediately knocked down
the second mate and carpenter with the butt-end of their muskets, being very
faithfully seconded by their men; they secured all the rest that were upon the
main and quarter decks, and began to fasten the hatches, to keep them down that
were below; when the other boat and their men, entering at the forechains,
secured the forecastle of the ship, and the scuttle which went down into the
cook-room, making three men they found there prisoners. When this was done, and
all safe upon deck, the captain ordered the mate, with three men, to break into
the round-house, where the new rebel captain lay, who, having taken the alarm,
had got up, and with two men and a boy had got firearms in their hands; and
when the mate, with a crow, split open the door, the new captain and his men
fired boldly among them, and wounded the mate with a musket ball, which broke
his arm, and wounded two more of the men, but killed nobody. The mate, calling
for help, rushed, however, into the round-house, wounded as he was, and, with
his pistol, shot the new captain through the head, the bullet entering at his
mouth, and came out again behind one of his ears, so that he never spoke a word
more: upon which the rest yielded, and the ship was taken effectually, without
any more lives lost.
As soon as the ship was thus secured, the
captain ordered seven guns to be fired, which was the signal agreed upon with
me to give me notice of his success, which, you may be sure, I was very glad to
hear, having sat watching upon the shore for it till near two o’clock in the
morning. Having thus heard the signal plainly, I laid me down; and it having
been a day of great fatigue to me, I slept very sound, till I was surprised
with the noise of a gun; and presently starting up, I heard a man call me by
the name of “Governor! Governor!” and presently I knew the captain’s voice; when,
climbing up to the top of the hill, there he stood, and, pointing to the ship,
he embraced me in his arms, “My dear friend and deliverer,” says he, “there’s
your ship; for she is all yours, and so are we, and all that belong to her.” I
cast my eyes to the ship, and there she rode, within little more than half a
mile of the shore; for they had weighed her anchor as soon as they were masters
of her, and, the weather being fair, had brought her to an anchor just against
the mouth of the little creek; and the tide being up, the captain had brought
the pinnace in near the place where I had first landed my rafts, and so landed
just at my door. I was at first ready to sink down with the surprise; for I saw
my deliverance, indeed, visibly put into my hands, all things easy, and a large
ship just ready to carry me away whither I pleased to go. At first, for some
time, I was not able to answer him one word; but as he had taken me in his arms
I held fast by him, or I should have fallen to the ground. He perceived the
surprise, and immediately pulled a bottle out of his pocket and gave me a dram
of cordial, which he had brought on purpose for me. After I had drunk it, I sat
down upon the ground; and though it brought me to myself, yet it was a good
while before I could speak a word to him. All this time the poor man was in as
great an ecstasy as I, only not under any surprise as I was; and he said a
thousand kind and tender things to me, to compose and bring me to myself; but
such was the flood of joy in my breast, that it put all my spirits into
confusion: at last it broke out into tears, and in a little while after I
recovered my speech; I then took my turn, and embraced him as my deliverer, and
we rejoiced together. I told him I looked upon him as a man sent by Heaven to
deliver me, and that the whole transaction seemed to be a chain of wonders;
that such things as these were the testimonies we had of a secret hand of
Providence governing the world, and an evidence that the eye of an infinite
Power could search into the remotest corner of the world, and send help to the
miserable whenever He pleased. I forgot not to lift up my heart in thankfulness
to Heaven; and what heart could forbear to bless Him, who had not only in a
miraculous manner provided for me in such a wilderness, and in such a desolate
condition, but from whom every deliverance must always be acknowledged to
proceed.
When we had talked a while, the captain
told me he had brought me some little refreshment, such as the ship afforded,
and such as the wretches that had been so long his masters had not plundered
him of. Upon this, he called aloud to the boat, and bade his men bring the
things ashore that were for the governor; and, indeed, it was a present as if I
had been one that was not to be carried away with them, but as if I had been to
dwell upon the island still. First, he had brought me a case of bottles full of
excellent cordial waters, six large bottles of Madeira wine (the bottles held
two quarts each), two pounds of excellent good tobacco, twelve good pieces of
the ship’s beef, and six pieces of pork, with a bag of peas, and about a
hundred-weight of biscuit; he also brought me a box of sugar, a box of flour, a
bag full of lemons, and two bottles of lime-juice, and abundance of other
things. But besides these, and what was a thousand times more useful to me, he
brought me six new clean shirts, six very good neckcloths, two pair of gloves,
one pair of shoes, a hat, and one pair of stockings, with a very good suit of
clothes of his own, which had been worn but very little: in a word, he clothed
me from head to foot. It was a very kind and agreeable present, as any one may
imagine, to one in my circumstances, but never was anything in the world of
that kind so unpleasant, awkward, and uneasy as it was to me to wear such
clothes at first.
After these ceremonies were past, and
after all his good things were brought into my little apartment, we began to
consult what was to be done with the prisoners we had; for it was worth
considering whether we might venture to take them with us or no, especially two
of them, whom he knew to be incorrigible and refractory to the last degree; and
the captain said he knew they were such rogues that there was no obliging them,
and if he did carry them away, it must be in irons, as malefactors, to be
delivered over to justice at the first English colony he could come to; and I
found that the captain himself was very anxious about it. Upon this, I told him
that, if he desired it, I would undertake to bring the two men he spoke of to
make it their own request that he should leave them upon the island. “I should
be very glad of that,” says the captain, “with all my heart.” “Well,” says I,
“I will send for them up and talk with them for you.” So I caused Friday and
the two hostages, for they were now discharged, their comrades having performed
their promise; I say, I caused them to go to the cave, and bring up the five
men, pinioned as they were, to the bower, and keep them there till I came.
After some time, I came thither dressed in my new habit; and now I was called
governor again. Being all met, and the captain with me, I caused the men to be
brought before me, and I told them I had got a full account of their villainous
behaviour to the captain, and how they had run away with the ship, and were
preparing to commit further robberies, but that Providence had ensnared them in
their own ways, and that they were fallen into the pit which they had dug for
others. I let them know that by my direction the ship had been seized; that she
lay now in the road; and they might see by-and-by that their new captain had
received the reward of his villainy, and that they would see him hanging at the
yard-arm; that, as to them, I wanted to know what they had to say why I should
not execute them as pirates taken in the fact, as by my commission they could
not doubt but I had authority so to do.
One of them answered in the name of the
rest, that they had nothing to say but this, that when they were taken the
captain promised them their lives, and they humbly implored my mercy. But I
told them I knew not what mercy to show them; for as for myself, I had resolved
to quit the island with all my men, and had taken passage with the captain to
go to England; and as for the captain, he could not carry them to England other
than as prisoners in irons, to be tried for mutiny and running away with the
ship; the consequence of which, they must needs know, would be the gallows; so
that I could not tell what was best for them, unless they had a mind to take
their fate in the island. If they desired that, as I had liberty to leave the
island, I had some inclination to give them their lives, if they thought they
could shift on shore. They seemed very thankful for it, and said they would
much rather venture to stay there than be carried to England to be hanged. So I
left it on that issue.
However, the captain seemed to make some
difficulty of it, as if he durst not leave them there. Upon this I seemed a
little angry with the captain, and told him that they were my prisoners, not
his; and that seeing I had offered them so much favour, I would be as good as
my word; and that if he did not think fit to consent to it I would set them at
liberty, as I found them: and if he did not like it he might take them again if
he could catch them. Upon this they appeared very thankful, and I accordingly
set them at liberty, and bade them retire into the woods, to the place whence
they came, and I would leave them some firearms, some ammunition, and some
directions how they should live very well if they thought fit. Upon this I
prepared to go on board the ship; but told the captain I would stay that night
to prepare my things, and desired him to go on board in the meantime, and keep
all right in the ship, and send the boat on shore next day for me; ordering
him, at all events, to cause the new captain, who was killed, to be hanged at
the yard-arm, that these men might see him.
When the captain was gone I sent for the
men up to me to my apartment, and entered seriously into discourse with them on
their circumstances. I told them I thought they had made a right choice; that
if the captain had carried them away they would certainly be hanged. I showed
them the new captain hanging at the yard-arm of the ship, and told them they
had nothing less to expect.
When they had all declared their
willingness to stay, I then told them I would let them into the story of my
living there, and put them into the way of making it easy to them. Accordingly,
I gave them the whole history of the place, and of my coming to it; showed them
my fortifications, the way I made my bread, planted my corn, cured my grapes;
and, in a word, all that was necessary to make them easy. I told them the story
also of the seventeen Spaniards that were to be expected, for whom I left a
letter, and made them promise to treat them in common with themselves. Here it
may be noted that the captain, who had ink on board, was greatly surprised that
I never hit upon a way of making ink of charcoal and water, or of something
else, as I had done things much more difficult.
I left them my firearms—viz. five muskets,
three fowling-pieces, and three swords. I had above a barrel and a half of
powder left; for after the first year or two I used but little, and wasted
none. I gave them a description of the way I managed the goats, and directions
to milk and fatten them, and to make both butter and cheese. In a word, I gave
them every part of my own story; and told them I should prevail with the
captain to leave them two barrels of gunpowder more, and some garden-seeds,
which I told them I would have been very glad of. Also, I gave them the bag of
peas which the captain had brought me to eat, and bade them be sure to sow and
increase them.
3/23-a Wednesday-RC-Ch. 20 of 20=
1q "Fight between Friday and _____" What?
Answer=
"a bear."
2q How long did Robinson Cruscoe stay?
Answer="about 20
days."
3q What supplies did he leave?
Answer= "arms, (gun)
powder, shot, clothes, tools & 2 workmen."
4q Where were the "2 workmen" from?
Answer=
"England"
5q What kind of workmen were they?
Answer= "a carpenter
& a (black) smith."
BQ What's a "bark"?
Answer=According to kidzsearch.com,
"a small, sailing ship." ("barque").
3/24
CHAPTER XIX.
RETURN TO ENGLAND
Having done all this I left them the next
day, and went on board the ship. We prepared immediately to sail, but did not
weigh that night. The next morning early, two of the five men came swimming to
the ship’s side, and making the most lamentable complaint of the other three, begged
to be taken into the ship for God’s sake, for they should be murdered, and
begged the captain to take them on board, though he hanged them immediately.
Upon this the captain pretended to have no power without me; but after some
difficulty, and after their solemn promises of amendment, they were taken on
board, and were, some time after, soundly whipped and pickled; after which they
proved very honest and quiet fellows.
Some time after this, the boat was ordered
on shore, the tide being up, with the things promised to the men; to which the
captain, at my intercession, caused their chests and clothes to be added, which
they took, and were very thankful for. I also encouraged them, by telling them
that if it lay in my power to send any vessel to take them in, I would not
forget them.
When I took leave of this island, I
carried on board, for relics, the great goat-skin cap I had made, my umbrella,
and one of my parrots; also, I forgot not to take the money I formerly
mentioned, which had lain by me so long useless that it was grown rusty or
tarnished, and could hardly pass for silver till it had been a little rubbed
and handled, as also the money I found in the wreck of the Spanish ship. And
thus I left the island, the 19th of December, as I found by the ship’s account,
in the year 1686, after I had been upon it eight-and-twenty years, two months,
and nineteen days; being delivered from this second captivity the same day of
the month that I first made my escape in the long-boat from among the Moors of
Sallee. In this vessel, after a long voyage, I arrived in England the 11th of
June, in the year 1687, having been thirty-five years absent.
When I came to England I was as perfect a
stranger to all the world as if I had never been known there. My benefactor and
faithful steward, whom I had left my money in trust with, was alive, but had
had great misfortunes in the world; was become a widow the second time, and
very low in the world. I made her very easy as to what she owed me, assuring
her I would give her no trouble; but, on the contrary, in gratitude for her
former care and faithfulness to me, I relieved her as my little stock would
afford; which at that time would, indeed, allow me to do but little for her;
but I assured her I would never forget her former kindness to me; nor did I
forget her when I had sufficient to help her, as shall be observed in its
proper place. I went down afterwards into Yorkshire; but my father was dead,
and my mother and all the family extinct, except that I found two sisters, and
two of the children of one of my brothers; and as I had been long ago given
over for dead, there had been no provision made for me; so that, in a word, I
found nothing to relieve or assist me; and that the little money I had would
not do much for me as to settling in the world.
I met with one piece of gratitude indeed,
which I did not expect; and this was, that the master of the ship, whom I had
so happily delivered, and by the same means saved the ship and cargo, having
given a very handsome account to the owners of the manner how I had saved the
lives of the men and the ship, they invited me to meet them and some other
merchants concerned, and all together made me a very handsome compliment upon
the subject, and a present of almost £200 sterling.
But after making several reflections upon
the circumstances of my life, and how little way this would go towards settling
me in the world, I resolved to go to Lisbon, and see if I might not come at
some information of the state of my plantation in the Brazils, and of what was
become of my partner, who, I had reason to suppose, had some years past given
me over for dead. With this view I took shipping for Lisbon, where I arrived in
April following, my man Friday accompanying me very honestly in all these
ramblings, and proving a most faithful servant upon all occasions. When I came
to Lisbon, I found out, by inquiry, and to my particular satisfaction, my old
friend, the captain of the ship who first took me up at sea off the shore of
Africa. He was now grown old, and had left off going to sea, having put his
son, who was far from a young man, into his ship, and who still used the Brazil
trade. The old man did not know me, and indeed I hardly knew him. But I soon
brought him to my remembrance, and as soon brought myself to his remembrance,
when I told him who I was.
After some passionate expressions of the
old acquaintance between us, I inquired, you may be sure, after my plantation
and my partner. The old man told me he had not been in the Brazils for about
nine years; but that he could assure me that when he came away my partner was
living, but the trustees whom I had joined with him to take cognisance of my
part were both dead: that, however, he believed I would have a very good
account of the improvement of the plantation; for that, upon the general belief
of my being cast away and drowned, my trustees had given in the account of the
produce of my part of the plantation to the procurator-fiscal, who had
appropriated it, in case I never came to claim it, one-third to the king, and
two-thirds to the monastery of St. Augustine, to be expended for the benefit of
the poor, and for the conversion of the Indians to the Catholic faith: but
that, if I appeared, or any one for me, to claim the inheritance, it would be
restored; only that the improvement, or annual production, being distributed to
charitable uses, could not be restored: but he assured me that the steward of
the king’s revenue from lands, and the providore, or steward of the monastery,
had taken great care all along that the incumbent, that is to say my partner,
gave every year a faithful account of the produce, of which they had duly
received my moiety. I asked him if he knew to what height of improvement he had
brought the plantation, and whether he thought it might be worth looking after;
or whether, on my going thither, I should meet with any obstruction to my
possessing my just right in the moiety. He told me he could not tell exactly to
what degree the plantation was improved; but this he knew, that my partner was grown
exceeding rich upon the enjoying his part of it; and that, to the best of his
remembrance, he had heard that the king’s third of my part, which was, it
seems, granted away to some other monastery or religious house, amounted to
above two hundred moidores a year: that as to my being restored to a quiet
possession of it, there was no question to be made of that, my partner being
alive to witness my title, and my name being also enrolled in the register of
the country; also he told me that the survivors of my two trustees were very
fair, honest people, and very wealthy; and he believed I would not only have
their assistance for putting me in possession, but would find a very
considerable sum of money in their hands for my account, being the produce of the
farm while their fathers held the trust, and before it was given up, as above;
which, as he remembered, was for about twelve years.
I showed myself a little concerned and
uneasy at this account, and inquired of the old captain how it came to pass
that the trustees should thus dispose of my effects, when he knew that I had
made my will, and had made him, the Portuguese captain, my universal heir,
&c.
He told me that was true; but that as
there was no proof of my being dead, he could not act as executor until some
certain account should come of my death; and, besides, he was not willing to
intermeddle with a thing so remote: that it was true he had registered my will,
and put in his claim; and could he have given any account of my being dead or
alive, he would have acted by procuration, and taken possession of the ingenio
(so they call the sugar-house), and have given his son, who was now at the
Brazils, orders to do it. “But,” says the old man, “I have one piece of news to
tell you, which perhaps may not be so acceptable to you as the rest; and that
is, believing you were lost, and all the world believing so also, your partner
and trustees did offer to account with me, in your name, for the first six or
eight years’ profits, which I received. There being at that time great
disbursements for increasing the works, building an ingenio, and buying slaves,
it did not amount to near so much as afterwards it produced; however,” says the
old man, “I shall give you a true account of what I have received in all, and
how I have disposed of it.”
After a few days’ further conference with
this ancient friend, he brought me an account of the first six years’ income of
my plantation, signed by my partner and the merchant-trustees, being always
delivered in goods, viz. tobacco in roll, and sugar in chests, besides rum,
molasses, &c., which is the consequence of a sugar-work; and I found by
this account, that every year the income considerably increased; but, as above,
the disbursements being large, the sum at first was small: however, the old man
let me see that he was debtor to me four hundred and seventy moidores of gold,
besides sixty chests of sugar and fifteen double rolls of tobacco, which were
lost in his ship; he having been shipwrecked coming home to Lisbon, about
eleven years after my having the place. The good man then began to complain of
his misfortunes, and how he had been obliged to make use of my money to recover
his losses, and buy him a share in a new ship. “However, my old friend,” says
he, “you shall not want a supply in your necessity; and as soon as my son
returns you shall be fully satisfied.” Upon this he pulls out an old pouch, and
gives me one hundred and sixty Portugal moidores in gold; and giving the
writings of his title to the ship, which his son was gone to the Brazils in, of
which he was quarter-part owner, and his son another, he puts them both into my
hands for security of the rest.
I was too much moved with the honesty and
kindness of the poor man to be able to bear this; and remembering what he had
done for me, how he had taken me up at sea, and how generously he had used me
on all occasions, and particularly how sincere a friend he was now to me, I
could hardly refrain weeping at what he had said to me; therefore I asked him
if his circumstances admitted him to spare so much money at that time, and if
it would not straiten him? He told me he could not say but it might straiten
him a little; but, however, it was my money, and I might want it more than he.
Everything the good man said was full of
affection, and I could hardly refrain from tears while he spoke; in short, I
took one hundred of the moidores, and called for a pen and ink to give him a
receipt for them: then I returned him the rest, and told him if ever I had
possession of the plantation I would return the other to him also (as, indeed,
I afterwards did); and that as to the bill of sale of his part in his son’s
ship, I would not take it by any means; but that if I wanted the money, I found
he was honest enough to pay me; and if I did not, but came to receive what he
gave me reason to expect, I would never have a penny more from him.
When this was past, the old man asked me
if he should put me into a method to make my claim to my plantation. I told him
I thought to go over to it myself. He said I might do so if I pleased, but that
if I did not, there were ways enough to secure my right, and immediately to
appropriate the profits to my use: and as there were ships in the river of
Lisbon just ready to go away to Brazil, he made me enter my name in a public
register, with his affidavit, affirming, upon oath, that I was alive, and that
I was the same person who took up the land for the planting the said plantation
at first. This being regularly attested by a notary, and a procuration affixed,
he directed me to send it, with a letter of his writing, to a merchant of his
acquaintance at the place; and then proposed my staying with him till an
account came of the return.
Never was anything more honourable than
the proceedings upon this procuration; for in less than seven months I received
a large packet from the survivors of my trustees, the merchants, for whose
account I went to sea, in which were the following, particular letters and
papers enclosed:—
First, there was the account-current of
the produce of my farm or plantation, from the year when their fathers had
balanced with my old Portugal captain, being for six years; the balance
appeared to be one thousand one hundred and seventy-four moidores in my favour.
Secondly, there was the account of four
years more, while they kept the effects in their hands, before the government
claimed the administration, as being the effects of a person not to be found,
which they called civil death; and the balance of this, the value of the
plantation increasing, amounted to nineteen thousand four hundred and forty-six
crusadoes, being about three thousand two hundred and forty moidores.
Thirdly, there was the Prior of St.
Augustine’s account, who had received the profits for above fourteen years; but
not being able to account for what was disposed of by the hospital, very
honestly declared he had eight hundred and seventy-two moidores not
distributed, which he acknowledged to my account: as to the king’s part, that
refunded nothing.
3/24-a Thursday-RC-
Ch.19/as Tuesday 3/22/ of 20=
1q "Returning to_______" where?
Answer= "England."
2q How long was "the account"?
Answer= "4 years more"
3q Whose account was it?
Answer= "the Prior of St. Augustine" (Saint= St. not Street)
4q How long was "the Prior of St. Augustine"'s account?
Answer= "14 years +"
5q How many
"moidores" were there? Answer= "872" or a moidoire is
Portuguese money, 1 moidore= UK 27 shillings or 20 shillings= 1 UK pound so 872
x 27 shillings= 23,544 UK shillings divided by 20= UK pounds 1177.20 or US$
1,567.43.
BQ How many
"cruscadoes" were there? Answer= "19, 446" or Portuguese or
Brazilian (Cruzado) money again= currently, in Brazilian Real, = 19 Real= US $
3.42 or 19, 446 divided by 19= US $ 1, 023.47.
3/25
There
was a letter of my partner’s, congratulating me very affectionately upon my
being alive, giving me an account how the estate was improved, and what it produced a year; with the
particulars of the number of squares, or acres that it contained, how planted,
how many slaves there were upon it: and making two-and-twenty crosses for
blessings, told me he had said so many Ave Marias to thank the
Blessed Virgin that I was alive; inviting me very passionately to come over and
take possession of my own, and in the meantime to give him orders to whom he
should deliver my effects if I did not come myself; concluding with a hearty
tender of his friendship, and that of his family; and sent me as a present
seven fine leopards’ skins, which he had, it seems, received from Africa, by
some other ship that he had sent thither, and which, it seems, had made a
better voyage than I. He sent me also five chests of excellent sweetmeats, and
a hundred pieces of gold uncoined, not quite so large as moidores. By the same
fleet my two merchant-trustees shipped me one thousand two hundred chests of
sugar, eight hundred rolls of tobacco, and the rest of the whole account in
gold.
I might well say now, indeed, that the
latter end of Job was better than the beginning. It is impossible to express
the flutterings of my very heart when I found all my wealth about me; for as
the Brazil ships come all in fleets, the same ships which brought my letters
brought my goods: and the effects were safe in the river before the letters
came to my hand. In a word, I turned pale, and grew sick; and, had not the old
man run and fetched me a cordial, I believe the sudden surprise of joy had
overset nature, and I had died upon the spot: nay, after that I continued very
ill, and was so some hours, till a physician being sent for, and something of
the real cause of my illness being known, he ordered me to be let blood; after
which I had relief, and grew well: but I verily believe, if I had not been
eased by a vent given in that manner to the spirits, I should have died.
I was now master, all on a sudden, of
above five thousand pounds sterling in money, and had an estate, as I might
well call it, in the Brazils, of above a thousand pounds a year, as sure as an
estate of lands in England: and, in a word, I was in a condition which I scarce
knew how to understand, or how to compose myself for the enjoyment of it. The
first thing I did was to recompense my original benefactor, my good old
captain, who had been first charitable to me in my distress, kind to me in my
beginning, and honest to me at the end. I showed him all that was sent to me; I
told him that, next to the providence of Heaven, which disposed all things, it
was owing to him; and that it now lay on me to reward him, which I would do a
hundred-fold: so I first returned to him the hundred moidores I had received of
him; then I sent for a notary, and caused him to draw up a general release or
discharge from the four hundred and seventy moidores, which he had acknowledged
he owed me, in the fullest and firmest manner possible. After which I caused a
procuration to be drawn, empowering him to be the receiver of the annual
profits of my plantation: and appointing my partner to account with him, and
make the returns, by the usual fleets, to him in my name; and by a clause in
the end, made a grant of one hundred moidores a year to him during his life,
out of the effects, and fifty moidores a year to his son after him, for his
life: and thus I requited my old man.
I had now to consider which way to steer
my course next, and what to do with the estate that Providence had thus put into
my hands; and, indeed, I had more care upon my head now than I had in my state
of life in the island where I wanted nothing but what I had, and had nothing
but what I wanted; whereas I had now a great charge upon me, and my business
was how to secure it. I had not a cave now to hide my money in, or a place
where it might lie without lock or key, till it grew mouldy and tarnished
before anybody would meddle with it; on the contrary, I knew not where to put
it, or whom to trust with it. My old patron, the captain, indeed, was honest,
and that was the only refuge I had. In the next place, my interest in the
Brazils seemed to summon me thither; but now I could not tell how to think of
going thither till I had settled my affairs, and left my effects in some safe
hands behind me. At first I thought of my old friend the widow, who I knew was
honest, and would be just to me; but then she was in years, and but poor, and,
for aught I knew, might be in debt: so that, in a word, I had no way but to go
back to England myself and take my effects with me.
It was some months, however, before I
resolved upon this; and, therefore, as I had rewarded the old captain fully,
and to his satisfaction, who had been my former benefactor, so I began to think
of the poor widow, whose husband had been my first benefactor, and she, while
it was in her power, my faithful steward and instructor. So, the first thing I
did, I got a merchant in Lisbon to write to his correspondent in London, not
only to pay a bill, but to go find her out, and carry her, in money, a hundred
pounds from me, and to talk with her, and comfort her in her poverty, by
telling her she should, if I lived, have a further supply: at the same time I
sent my two sisters in the country a hundred pounds each, they being, though
not in want, yet not in very good circumstances; one having been married and
left a widow; and the other having a husband not so kind to her as he should
be. But among all my relations or acquaintances I could not yet pitch upon one
to whom I durst commit the gross of my stock, that I might go away to the
Brazils, and leave things safe behind me; and this greatly perplexed me.
I had once a mind to have gone to the
Brazils and have settled myself there, for I was, as it were, naturalised to
the place; but I had some little scruple in my mind about religion, which
insensibly drew me back. However, it was not religion that kept me from going
there for the present; and as I had made no scruple of being openly of the
religion of the country all the while I was among them, so neither did I yet;
only that, now and then, having of late thought more of it than formerly, when
I began to think of living and dying among them, I began to regret having
professed myself a Papist, and thought it might not be the best religion to die
with.
But, as I have said, this was not the main
thing that kept me from going to the Brazils, but that really I did not know
with whom to leave my effects behind me; so I resolved at last to go to
England, where, if I arrived, I concluded that I should make some acquaintance,
or find some relations, that would be faithful to me; and, accordingly, I
prepared to go to England with all my wealth.
In order to prepare things for my going
home, I first (the Brazil fleet being just going away) resolved to give answers
suitable to the just and faithful account of things I had from thence; and,
first, to the Prior of St. Augustine I wrote a letter full of thanks for his
just dealings, and the offer of the eight hundred and seventy-two moidores
which were undisposed of, which I desired might be given, five hundred to the
monastery, and three hundred and seventy-two to the poor, as the prior should
direct; desiring the good padre’s prayers for me, and the like. I wrote next a
letter of thanks to my two trustees, with all the acknowledgment that so much
justice and honesty called for: as for sending them any present, they were far
above having any occasion of it. Lastly, I wrote to my partner, acknowledging
his industry in the improving the plantation, and his integrity in increasing
the stock of the works; giving him instructions for his future government of my
part, according to the powers I had left with my old patron, to whom I desired
him to send whatever became due to me, till he should hear from me more
particularly; assuring him that it was my intention not only to come to him,
but to settle myself there for the remainder of my life. To this I added a very
handsome present of some Italian silks for his wife and two daughters, for such
the captain’s son informed me he had; with two pieces of fine English
broadcloth, the best I could get in Lisbon, five pieces of black baize, and
some Flanders lace of a good value.
Having thus settled my affairs, sold my
cargo, and turned all my effects into good bills of exchange, my next
difficulty was which way to go to England: I had been accustomed enough to the
sea, and yet I had a strange aversion to go to England by the sea at that time,
and yet I could give no reason for it, yet the difficulty increased upon me so
much, that though I had once shipped my baggage in order to go, yet I altered
my mind, and that not once but two or three times.
It is true I had been very unfortunate by
sea, and this might be one of the reasons; but let no man slight the strong
impulses of his own thoughts in cases of such moment: two of the ships which I
had singled out to go in, I mean more particularly singled out than any other,
having put my things on board one of them, and in the other having agreed with
the captain; I say two of these ships miscarried. One was taken by the
Algerines, and the other was lost on the Start, near Torbay, and all the people
drowned except three; so that in either of those vessels I had been made
miserable.
Having been thus harassed in my thoughts,
my old pilot, to whom I communicated everything, pressed me earnestly not to go
by sea, but either to go by land to the Groyne, and cross over the Bay of
Biscay to Rochelle, from whence it was but an easy and safe journey by land to
Paris, and so to Calais and Dover; or to go up to Madrid, and so all the way by
land through France. In a word, I was so prepossessed against my going by sea
at all, except from Calais to Dover, that I resolved to travel all the way by
land; which, as I was not in haste, and did not value the charge, was by much
the pleasanter way: and to make it more so, my old captain brought an English
gentleman, the son of a merchant in Lisbon, who was willing to travel with me;
after which we picked up two more English merchants also, and two young
Portuguese gentlemen, the last going to Paris only; so that in all there were
six of us and five servants; the two merchants and the two Portuguese,
contenting themselves with one servant between two, to save the charge; and as
for me, I got an English sailor to travel with me as a servant, besides my man
Friday, who was too much a stranger to be capable of supplying the place of a
servant on the road.
In this manner I set out from Lisbon; and
our company being very well mounted and armed, we made a little troop, whereof
they did me the honour to call me captain, as well because I was the oldest
man, as because I had two servants, and, indeed, was the origin of the whole
journey.
As I have troubled you with none of my sea
journals, so I shall trouble you now with none of my land journals; but some
adventures that happened to us in this tedious and difficult journey I must not
omit.
When we came to Madrid, we, being all of
us strangers to Spain, were willing to stay some time to see the court of
Spain, and what was worth observing; but it being the latter part of the
summer, we hastened away, and set out from Madrid about the middle of October;
but when we came to the edge of Navarre, we were alarmed, at several towns on
the way, with an account that so much snow was falling on the French side of
the mountains, that several travellers were obliged to come back to Pampeluna,
after having attempted at an extreme hazard to pass on.
When we came to Pampeluna itself, we found
it so indeed; and to me, that had been always used to a hot climate, and to
countries where I could scarce bear any clothes on, the cold was insufferable;
nor, indeed, was it more painful than surprising to come but ten days before
out of Old Castile, where the weather was not only warm but very hot, and
immediately to feel a wind from the Pyrenean Mountains so very keen, so
severely cold, as to be intolerable and to endanger benumbing and perishing of
our fingers and toes.
Poor Friday was really frightened when he
saw the mountains all covered with snow, and felt cold weather, which he had
never seen or felt before in his life. To mend the matter, when we came to
Pampeluna it continued snowing with so much violence and so long, that the
people said winter was come before its time; and the roads, which were
difficult before, were now quite impassable; for, in a word, the snow lay in
some places too thick for us to travel, and being not hard frozen, as is the
case in the northern countries, there was no going without being in danger of
being buried alive every step. We stayed no less than twenty days at Pampeluna;
when (seeing the winter coming on, and no likelihood of its being better, for
it was the severest winter all over Europe that had been known in the memory of
man) I proposed that we should go away to Fontarabia, and there take shipping
for Bordeaux, which was a very little voyage. But, while I was considering
this, there came in four French gentlemen, who, having been stopped on the
French side of the passes, as we were on the Spanish, had found out a guide,
who, traversing the country near the head of Languedoc, had brought them over
the mountains by such ways that they were not much incommoded with the snow;
for where they met with snow in any quantity, they said it was frozen hard
enough to bear them and their horses. We sent for this guide, who told us he
would undertake to carry us the same way, with no hazard from the snow,
provided we were armed sufficiently to protect ourselves from wild beasts; for,
he said, in these great snows it was frequent for some wolves to show
themselves at the foot of the mountains, being made ravenous for want of food,
the ground being covered with snow. We told him we were well enough prepared
for such creatures as they were, if he would insure us from a kind of
two-legged wolves, which we were told we were in most danger from, especially
on the French side of the mountains. He satisfied us that there was no danger
of that kind in the way that we were to go; so we readily agreed to follow him,
as did also twelve other gentlemen with their servants, some French, some
Spanish, who, as I said, had attempted to go, and were obliged to come back
again.
Accordingly, we set out from Pampeluna
with our guide on the 15th of November; and indeed I was surprised when, instead
of going forward, he came directly back with us on the same road that we came
from Madrid, about twenty miles; when, having passed two rivers, and come into
the plain country, we found ourselves in a warm climate again, where the
country was pleasant, and no snow to be seen; but, on a sudden, turning to his
left, he approached the mountains another way; and though it is true the hills
and precipices looked dreadful, yet he made so many tours, such meanders, and
led us by such winding ways, that we insensibly passed the height of the
mountains without being much encumbered with the snow; and all on a sudden he
showed us the pleasant and fruitful provinces of Languedoc and Gascony, all
green and flourishing, though at a great distance, and we had some rough way to
pass still.
We were a little uneasy, however, when we
found it snowed one whole day and a night so fast that we could not travel; but
he bid us be easy; we should soon be past it all: we found, indeed, that we
began to descend every day, and to come more north than before; and so,
depending upon our guide, we went on.
It was about two hours before night when,
our guide being something before us, and not just in sight, out rushed three
monstrous wolves, and after them a bear, from a hollow way adjoining to a thick
wood; two of the wolves made at the guide, and had he been far before us, he
would have been devoured before we could have helped him; one of them fastened
upon his horse, and the other attacked the man with such violence, that he had not
time, or presence of mind enough, to draw his pistol, but hallooed and cried
out to us most lustily. My man Friday being next me, I bade him ride up and see
what was the matter. As soon as Friday came in sight of the man, he hallooed
out as loud as the other, “O master! O master!” but like a bold fellow, rode
directly up to the poor man, and with his pistol shot the wolf in the head that
attacked him.
It was happy for the poor man that it was
my man Friday; for, having been used to such creatures in his country, he had
no fear upon him, but went close up to him and shot him; whereas, any other of
us would have fired at a farther distance, and have perhaps either missed the
wolf or endangered shooting the man.
But it was enough to have terrified a
bolder man than I; and, indeed, it alarmed all our company, when, with the
noise of Friday’s pistol, we heard on both sides the most dismal howling of
wolves; and the noise, redoubled by the echo of the mountains, appeared to us
as if there had been a prodigious number of them; and perhaps there was not
such a few as that we had no cause of apprehension: however, as Friday had
killed this wolf, the other that had fastened upon the horse left him
immediately, and fled, without doing him any damage, having happily fastened
upon his head, where the bosses of the bridle had stuck in his teeth. But the
man was most hurt; for the raging creature had bit him twice, once in the arm,
and the other time a little above his knee; and though he had made some
defence, he was just tumbling down by the disorder of his horse, when Friday
came up and shot the wolf.
It is easy to suppose that at the noise of
Friday’s pistol we all mended our pace, and rode up as fast as the way, which
was very difficult, would give us leave, to see what was the matter. As soon as
we came clear of the trees, which blinded us before, we saw clearly what had
been the case, and how Friday had disengaged the poor guide, though we did not
presently discern what kind of creature it was he had killed.
3/25-a Friday-RC-Ch. 20/as Wednesday 3/23/ of 20=
1q "Fight between Friday and _____" What?
Answer=
"a bear."
2q How long did Robinson Cruscoe stay?
Answer="about 20
days."
3q What supplies did he leave?
Answer= "arms, (gun)
powder, shot, clothes, tools & 2 workmen."
4q Where were the "2 workmen" from?
Answer=
"England"
5q What kind of workmen were they?
Answer= "a carpenter
& a (black) smith."
BQ What's a "bark"?
Answer=According to kidzsearch.com,
"a small, sailing ship." ("barque").
3/28
CHAPTER XX.
FIGHT BETWEEN FRIDAY AND A BEAR
But never was a fight managed so hardily,
and in such a surprising manner as that which followed between Friday and the
bear, which gave us all, though at first we were surprised and afraid for him,
the greatest diversion imaginable. As the bear is a heavy, clumsy creature, and
does not gallop as the wolf does, who is swift and light, so he has two
particular qualities, which generally are the rule of his actions; first, as to
men, who are not his proper prey (he does not usually attempt them, except they
first attack him, unless he be excessively hungry, which it is probable might
now be the case, the ground being covered with snow), if you do not meddle with
him, he will not meddle with you; but then you must take care to be very civil
to him, and give him the road, for he is a very nice gentleman; he will not go
a step out of his way for a prince; nay, if you are really afraid, your best
way is to look another way and keep going on; for sometimes if you stop, and
stand still, and look steadfastly at him, he takes it for an affront; but if
you throw or toss anything at him, though it were but a bit of stick as big as
your finger, he thinks himself abused, and sets all other business aside to
pursue his revenge, and will have satisfaction in point of honour—that is his
first quality: the next is, if he be once affronted, he will never leave you,
night or day, till he has his revenge, but follows at a good round rate till he
overtakes you.
My man Friday had delivered our guide, and
when we came up to him he was helping him off his horse, for the man was both
hurt and frightened, when on a sudden we espied the bear come out of the wood;
and a monstrous one it was, the biggest by far that ever I saw. We were all a
little surprised when we saw him; but when Friday saw him, it was easy to see
joy and courage in the fellow’s countenance. “O! O! O!” says Friday, three
times, pointing to him; “O master, you give me te leave, me shakee te hand with
him; me makee you good laugh.”
I was surprised to see the fellow so well pleased.
“You fool,” says I, “he will eat you up.”—“Eatee me up! eatee me up!” says
Friday, twice over again; “me eatee him up; me makee you good laugh; you all
stay here, me show you good laugh.” So down he sits, and gets off his boots in
a moment, and puts on a pair of pumps (as we call the flat shoes they wear, and
which he had in his pocket), gives my other servant his horse, and with his gun
away he flew, swift like the wind.
The bear was walking softly on, and
offered to meddle with nobody, till Friday coming pretty near, calls to him, as
if the bear could understand him. “Hark ye, hark ye,” says Friday, “me speakee
with you.” We followed at a distance, for now being down on the Gascony side of
the mountains, we were entered a vast forest, where the country was plain and
pretty open, though it had many trees in it scattered here and there. Friday,
who had, as we say, the heels of the bear, came up with him quickly, and took
up a great stone, and threw it at him, and hit him just on the head, but did him
no more harm than if he had thrown it against a wall; but it answered Friday’s
end, for the rogue was so void of fear that he did it purely to make the bear
follow him, and show us some laugh as he called it. As soon as the bear felt
the blow, and saw him, he turns about and comes after him, taking very long
strides, and shuffling on at a strange rate, so as would have put a horse to a
middling gallop; away runs Friday, and takes his course as if he ran towards us
for help; so we all resolved to fire at once upon the bear, and deliver my man;
though I was angry at him for bringing the bear back upon us, when he was going
about his own business another way; and especially I was angry that he had
turned the bear upon us, and then ran away; and I called out, “You dog! is this
your making us laugh? Come away, and take your horse, that we may shoot the
creature.” He heard me, and cried out, “No shoot, no shoot; stand still, and
you get much laugh:” and as the nimble creature ran two feet for the bear’s
one, he turned on a sudden on one side of us, and seeing a great oak-tree fit
for his purpose, he beckoned to us to follow; and doubling his pace, he got
nimbly up the tree, laying his gun down upon the ground, at about five or six
yards from the bottom of the tree. The bear soon came to the tree, and we
followed at a distance: the first thing he did he stopped at the gun, smelt at
it, but let it lie, and up he scrambles into the tree, climbing like a cat,
though so monstrous heavy. I was amazed at the folly, as I thought it, of my
man, and could not for my life see anything to laugh at, till seeing the bear
get up the tree, we all rode near to him.
When we came to the tree, there was Friday
got out to the small end of a large branch, and the bear got about half-way to
him. As soon as the bear got out to that part where the limb of the tree was
weaker, “Ha!” says he to us, “now you see me teachee the bear dance:” so he
began jumping and shaking the bough, at which the bear began to totter, but
stood still, and began to look behind him, to see how he should get back; then,
indeed, we did laugh heartily. But Friday had not done with him by a great
deal; when seeing him stand still, he called out to him again, as if he had
supposed the bear could speak English, “What, you come no farther? pray you
come farther;” so he left jumping and shaking the tree; and the bear, just as
if he understood what he said, did come a little farther; then he began jumping
again, and the bear stopped again. We thought now was a good time to knock him
in the head, and called to Friday to stand still and we should shoot the bear:
but he cried out earnestly, “Oh, pray! Oh, pray! no shoot, me shoot by and
then:” he would have said by-and-by. However, to shorten the story, Friday
danced so much, and the bear stood so ticklish, that we had laughing enough,
but still could not imagine what the fellow would do: for first we thought he
depended upon shaking the bear off; and we found the bear was too cunning for
that too; for he would not go out far enough to be thrown down, but clung fast
with his great broad claws and feet, so that we could not imagine what would be
the end of it, and what the jest would be at last. But Friday put us out of
doubt quickly: for seeing the bear cling fast to the bough, and that he would
not be persuaded to come any farther, “Well, well,” says Friday, “you no come
farther, me go; you no come to me, me come to you;” and upon this he went out
to the smaller end, where it would bend with his weight, and gently let himself
down by it, sliding down the bough till he came near enough to jump down on his
feet, and away he ran to his gun, took it up, and stood still. “Well,” said I
to him, “Friday, what will you do now? Why don’t you shoot him?” “No shoot,”
says Friday, “no yet; me shoot now, me no kill; me stay, give you one more
laugh:” and, indeed, so he did; for when the bear saw his enemy gone, he came
back from the bough, where he stood, but did it very cautiously, looking behind
him every step, and coming backward till he got into the body of the tree,
then, with the same hinder end foremost, he came down the tree, grasping it
with his claws, and moving one foot at a time, very leisurely. At this
juncture, and just before he could set his hind foot on the ground, Friday
stepped up close to him, clapped the muzzle of his piece into his ear, and shot
him dead. Then the rogue turned about to see if we did not laugh; and when he
saw we were pleased by our looks, he began to laugh very loud. “So we kill bear
in my country,” says Friday. “So you kill them?” says I; “why, you have no
guns.”—“No,” says he, “no gun, but shoot great much long arrow.” This was a
good diversion to us; but we were still in a wild place, and our guide very
much hurt, and what to do we hardly knew; the howling of wolves ran much in my
head; and, indeed, except the noise I once heard on the shore of Africa, of
which I have said something already, I never heard anything that filled me with
so much horror.
These things, and the approach of night,
called us off, or else, as Friday would have had us, we should certainly have
taken the skin of this monstrous creature off, which was worth saving; but we
had near three leagues to go, and our guide hastened us; so we left him, and
went forward on our journey.
The ground was still covered with snow,
though not so deep and dangerous as on the mountains; and the ravenous
creatures, as we heard afterwards, were come down into the forest and plain
country, pressed by hunger, to seek for food, and had done a great deal of
mischief in the villages, where they surprised the country people, killed a
great many of their sheep and horses, and some people too.
We had one dangerous place to pass, and
our guide told us if there were more wolves in the country we should find them
there; and this was a small plain, surrounded with woods on every side, and a
long, narrow defile, or lane, which we were to pass to get through the wood,
and then we should come to the village where we were to lodge.
It was within half-an-hour of sunset when
we entered the wood, and a little after sunset when we came into the plain: we
met with nothing in the first wood, except that in a little plain within the
wood, which was not above two furlongs over, we saw five great wolves cross the
road, full speed, one after another, as if they had been in chase of some prey,
and had it in view; they took no notice of us, and were gone out of sight in a
few moments. Upon this, our guide, who, by the way, was but a fainthearted
fellow, bid us keep in a ready posture, for he believed there were more wolves
a-coming. We kept our arms ready, and our eyes about us; but we saw no more
wolves till we came through that wood, which was near half a league, and
entered the plain. As soon as we came into the plain, we had occasion enough to
look about us. The first object we met with was a dead horse; that is to say, a
poor horse which the wolves had killed, and at least a dozen of them at work,
we could not say eating him, but picking his bones rather; for they had eaten
up all the flesh before. We did not think fit to disturb them at their feast,
neither did they take much notice of us. Friday would have let fly at them, but
I would not suffer him by any means; for I found we were like to have more
business upon our hands than we were aware of. We had not gone half over the
plain when we began to hear the wolves howl in the wood on our left in a
frightful manner, and presently after we saw about a hundred coming on directly
towards us, all in a body, and most of them in a line, as regularly as an army
drawn up by experienced officers. I scarce knew in what manner to receive them,
but found to draw ourselves in a close line was the only way; so we formed in a
moment; but that we might not have too much interval, I ordered that only every
other man should fire, and that the others, who had not fired, should stand
ready to give them a second volley immediately, if they continued to advance
upon us; and then that those that had fired at first should not pretend to load
their fusees again, but stand ready, every one with a pistol, for we were all
armed with a fusee and a pair of pistols each man; so we were, by this method,
able to fire six volleys, half of us at a time; however, at present we had no
necessity; for upon firing the first volley, the enemy made a full stop, being
terrified as well with the noise as with the fire. Four of them being shot in
the head, dropped; several others were wounded, and went bleeding off, as we
could see by the snow. I found they stopped, but did not immediately retreat;
whereupon, remembering that I had been told that the fiercest creatures were
terrified at the voice of a man, I caused all the company to halloo as loud as
they could; and I found the notion not altogether mistaken; for upon our shout
they began to retire and turn about. I then ordered a second volley to be fired
in their rear, which put them to the gallop, and away they went to the woods.
This gave us leisure to charge our pieces again; and that we might lose no
time, we kept going; but we had but little more than loaded our fusees, and put
ourselves in readiness, when we heard a terrible noise in the same wood on our
left, only that it was farther onward, the same way we were to go.
The night was coming on, and the light
began to be dusky, which made it worse on our side; but the noise increasing,
we could easily perceive that it was the howling and yelling of those hellish
creatures; and on a sudden we perceived three troops of wolves, one on our
left, one behind us, and one in our front, so that we seemed to be surrounded
with them: however, as they did not fall upon us, we kept our way forward, as
fast as we could make our horses go, which, the way being very rough, was only
a good hard trot. In this manner, we came in view of the entrance of a wood,
through which we were to pass, at the farther side of the plain; but we were
greatly surprised, when coming nearer the lane or pass, we saw a confused
number of wolves standing just at the entrance. On a sudden, at another opening
of the wood, we heard the noise of a gun, and looking that way, out rushed a
horse, with a saddle and a bridle on him, flying like the wind, and sixteen or
seventeen wolves after him, full speed: the horse had the advantage of them;
but as we supposed that he could not hold it at that rate, we doubted not but
they would get up with him at last: no question but they did.
But here we had a most horrible sight; for
riding up to the entrance where the horse came out, we found the carcasses of
another horse and of two men, devoured by the ravenous creatures; and one of
the men was no doubt the same whom we heard fire the gun, for there lay a gun
just by him fired off; but as to the man, his head and the upper part of his
body was eaten up. This filled us with horror, and we knew not what course to
take; but the creatures resolved us soon, for they gathered about us presently,
in hopes of prey; and I verily believe there were three hundred of them. It
happened, very much to our advantage, that at the entrance into the wood, but a
little way from it, there lay some large timber-trees, which had been cut down
the summer before, and I suppose lay there for carriage. I drew my little troop
in among those trees, and placing ourselves in a line behind one long tree, I
advised them all to alight, and keeping that tree before us for a breastwork,
to stand in a triangle, or three fronts, enclosing our horses in the centre. We
did so, and it was well we did; for never was a more furious charge than the
creatures made upon us in this place. They came on with a growling kind of
noise, and mounted the piece of timber, which, as I said, was our breastwork,
as if they were only rushing upon their prey; and this fury of theirs, it
seems, was principally occasioned by their seeing our horses behind us. I
ordered our men to fire as before, every other man; and they took their aim so
sure that they killed several of the wolves at the first volley; but there was
a necessity to keep a continual firing, for they came on like devils, those
behind pushing on those before.
When we had fired a second volley of our
fusees, we thought they stopped a little, and I hoped they would have gone off,
but it was but a moment, for others came forward again; so we fired two volleys
of our pistols; and I believe in these four firings we had killed seventeen or
eighteen of them, and lamed twice as many, yet they came on again. I was loth
to spend our shot too hastily; so I called my servant, not my man Friday, for
he was better employed, for, with the greatest dexterity imaginable, he had
charged my fusee and his own while we were engaged—but, as I said, I called my
other man, and giving him a horn of powder, I had him lay a train all along the
piece of timber, and let it be a large train. He did so, and had but just time
to get away, when the wolves came up to it, and some got upon it, when I,
snapping an uncharged pistol close to the powder, set it on fire; those that
were upon the timber were scorched with it, and six or seven of them fell; or
rather jumped in among us with the force and fright of the fire; we despatched
these in an instant, and the rest were so frightened with the light, which the
night—for it was now very near dark—made more terrible that they drew back a
little; upon which I ordered our last pistols to be fired off in one volley,
and after that we gave a shout; upon this the wolves turned tail, and we
sallied immediately upon near twenty lame ones that we found struggling on the
ground, and fell to cutting them with our swords, which answered our expectation,
for the crying and howling they made was better understood by their fellows; so
that they all fled and left us.
We had, first and last, killed about
threescore of them, and had it been daylight we had killed many more. The field
of battle being thus cleared, we made forward again, for we had still near a
league to go. We heard the ravenous creatures howl and yell in the woods as we
went several times, and sometimes we fancied we saw some of them; but the snow
dazzling our eyes, we were not certain. In about an hour more we came to the
town where we were to lodge, which we found in a terrible fright and all in
arms; for, it seems, the night before the wolves and some bears had broken into
the village, and put them in such terror that they were obliged to keep guard
night and day, but especially in the night, to preserve their cattle, and
indeed their people.
The next morning our guide was so ill, and
his limbs swelled so much with the rankling of his two wounds, that he could go
no farther; so we were obliged to take a new guide here, and go to Toulouse,
where we found a warm climate, a fruitful, pleasant country, and no snow, no
wolves, nor anything like them; but when we told our story at Toulouse, they
told us it was nothing but what was ordinary in the great forest at the foot of
the mountains, especially when the snow lay on the ground; but they inquired
much what kind of guide we had got who would venture to bring us that way in
such a severe season, and told us it was surprising we were not all devoured.
When we told them how we placed ourselves and the horses in the middle, they
blamed us exceedingly, and told us it was fifty to one but we had been all
destroyed, for it was the sight of the horses which made the wolves so furious,
seeing their prey, and that at other times they are really afraid of a gun; but
being excessively hungry, and raging on that account, the eagerness to come at
the horses had made them senseless of danger, and that if we had not by the
continual fire, and at last by the stratagem of the train of powder, mastered
them, it had been great odds but that we had been torn to pieces; whereas, had
we been content to have sat still on horseback, and fired as horsemen, they
would not have taken the horses so much for their own, when men were on their
backs, as otherwise; and withal, they told us that at last, if we had stood
altogether, and left our horses, they would have been so eager to have devoured
them, that we might have come off safe, especially having our firearms in our
hands, being so many in number. For my part, I was never so sensible of danger
in my life; for, seeing above three hundred devils come roaring and
open-mouthed to devour us, and having nothing to shelter us or retreat to, I
gave myself over for lost; and, as it was, I believe I shall never care to
cross those mountains again: I think I would much rather go a thousand leagues
by sea, though I was sure to meet with a storm once a-week.
I have nothing uncommon to take notice of
in my passage through France—nothing but what other travellers have given an
account of with much more advantage than I can. I travelled from Toulouse to
Paris, and without any considerable stay came to Calais, and landed safe at
Dover the 14th of January, after having had a severe cold season to travel in.
I was now come to the centre of my
travels, and had in a little time all my new-discovered estate safe about me,
the bills of exchange which I brought with me having been currently paid.
My principal guide and privy-counsellor
was my good ancient widow, who, in gratitude for the money I had sent her,
thought no pains too much nor care too great to employ for me; and I trusted
her so entirely that I was perfectly easy as to the security of my effects;
and, indeed, I was very happy from the beginning, and now to the end, in the
unspotted integrity of this good gentlewoman.
And now, having resolved to dispose of my
plantation in the Brazils, I wrote to my old friend at Lisbon, who, having
offered it to the two merchants, the survivors of my trustees, who lived in the
Brazils, they accepted the offer, and remitted thirty-three thousand pieces of
eight to a correspondent of theirs at Lisbon to pay for it.
In return, I signed the instrument of sale
in the form which they sent from Lisbon, and sent it to my old man, who sent me
the bills of exchange for thirty-two thousand eight hundred pieces of eight for
the estate, reserving the payment of one hundred moidores a year to him (the
old man) during his life, and fifty moidores afterwards to his son for his life,
which I had promised them, and which the plantation was to make good as a
rent-charge. And thus I have given the first part of a life of fortune and
adventure—a life of Providence’s chequer-work, and of a variety which the world
will seldom be able to show the like of; beginning foolishly, but closing much
more happily than any part of it ever gave me leave so much as to hope for.
Any one would think that in this state of
complicated good fortune I was past running any more hazards—and so, indeed, I had
been, if other circumstances had concurred; but I was inured to a wandering
life, had no family, nor many relations; nor, however rich, had I contracted
fresh acquaintance; and though I had sold my estate in the Brazils, yet I could
not keep that country out of my head, and had a great mind to be upon the wing
again; especially I could not resist the strong inclination I had to see my
island, and to know if the poor Spaniards were in being there. My true friend,
the widow, earnestly dissuaded me from it, and so far prevailed with me, that
for almost seven years she prevented my running abroad, during which time I
took my two nephews, the children of one of my brothers, into my care; the
eldest, having something of his own, I bred up as a gentleman, and gave him a
settlement of some addition to his estate after my decease. The other I placed
with the captain of a ship; and after five years, finding him a sensible, bold,
enterprising young fellow, I put him into a good ship, and sent him to sea; and
this young fellow afterwards drew me in, as old as I was, to further adventures
myself.
In the meantime, I in part settled myself
here; for, first of all, I married, and that not either to my disadvantage or
dissatisfaction, and had three children, two sons and one daughter; but my wife
dying, and my nephew coming home with good success from a voyage to Spain, my
inclination to go abroad, and his importunity, prevailed, and engaged me to go
in his ship as a private trader to the East Indies; this was in the year 1694.
In this voyage I visited my new colony in
the island, saw my successors the Spaniards, had the old story of their lives
and of the villains I left there; how at first they insulted the poor
Spaniards, how they afterwards agreed, disagreed, united, separated, and how at
last the Spaniards were obliged to use violence with them; how they were
subjected to the Spaniards, how honestly the Spaniards used them—a history, if
it were entered into, as full of variety and wonderful accidents as my own
part—particularly, also, as to their battles with the Caribbeans, who landed
several times upon the island, and as to the improvement they made upon the
island itself, and how five of them made an attempt upon the mainland, and
brought away eleven men and five women prisoners, by which, at my coming, I
found about twenty young children on the island.
Here I stayed about twenty days, left them
supplies of all necessary things, and particularly of arms, powder, shot,
clothes, tools, and two workmen, which I had brought from England with me, viz.
a carpenter and a smith.
Besides this, I shared the lands into
parts with them, reserved to myself the property of the whole, but gave them
such parts respectively as they agreed on; and having settled all things with
them, and engaged them not to leave the place, I left them there.
From thence I touched at the Brazils, from
whence I sent a bark, which I bought there, with more people to the island; and
in it, besides other supplies, I sent seven women, being such as I found proper
for service, or for wives to such as would take them. As to the Englishmen, I
promised to send them some women from England, with a good cargo of
necessaries, if they would apply themselves to planting—which I afterwards
could not perform. The fellows proved very honest and diligent after they were
mastered and had their properties set apart for them. I sent them, also, from
the Brazils, five cows, three of them being big with calf, some sheep, and some
hogs, which when I came again were considerably increased.
But all these things, with an account how
three hundred Caribbees came and invaded them, and ruined their plantations,
and how they fought with that whole number twice, and were at first defeated,
and one of them killed; but at last, a storm destroying their enemies’ canoes,
they famished or destroyed almost all the rest, and renewed and recovered the
possession of their plantation, and still lived upon the island.
All these things, with some very
surprising incidents in some new adventures of my own, for ten years more, I
shall give a farther account of in the Second Part of my Story.
3/28-a Monday-RC-Ch.20/as above/ of 20=
1q "Fight between Friday and _____" What?
Answer=
"a bear."
2q How long did Robinson Cruscoe stay?
Answer="about 20
days."
3q What supplies did he leave?
Answer= "arms, (gun) powder,
shot, clothes, tools & 2 workmen."
4q Where were the "2 workmen" from?
Answer=
"England"
5q What kind of workmen were they?
Answer= "a carpenter
& a (black) smith."
BQ What's a "bark"?
Answer=According to kidzsearch.com, "a small, sailing
ship." ("barque").
*** END OF THE PROJECT
GUTENBERG EBOOK THE LIFE AND ADVENTURES OF ROBINSON CRUSOE ***
3/29
環遊世界八十天
Around the
World in Eighty Days
by Jules Verne
CHAPTER I.
IN WHICH PHILEAS FOGG AND PASSEPARTOUT ACCEPT EACH OTHER, THE ONE AS MASTER,
THE OTHER AS MAN
Mr. Phileas Fogg lived,
in 1872, at No. 7, Saville Row, Burlington Gardens, the house in which Sheridan
died in 1814. He was one of the most noticeable members of the Reform Club,
though he seemed always to avoid attracting attention; an enigmatical
personage, about whom little was known, except that he was a polished man of
the world. People said that he resembled Byron—at least that his head was
Byronic; but he was a bearded, tranquil Byron, who might live on a thousand
years without growing old.
Certainly an Englishman,
it was more doubtful whether Phileas Fogg was a Londoner. He was never seen on
’Change, nor at the Bank, nor in the counting-rooms of the “City”; no ships
ever came into London docks of which he was the owner; he had no public
employment; he had never been entered at any of the Inns of Court, either at
the Temple, or Lincoln’s Inn, or Gray’s Inn; nor had his voice ever resounded
in the Court of Chancery, or in the Exchequer, or the Queen’s Bench, or the
Ecclesiastical Courts. He certainly was not a manufacturer; nor was he a
merchant or a gentleman farmer. His name was strange to the scientific and
learned societies, and he never was known to take part in the sage
deliberations of the Royal Institution or the London Institution, the Artisan’s
Association, or the Institution of Arts and Sciences. He belonged, in fact, to
none of the numerous societies which swarm in the English capital, from the
Harmonic to that of the Entomologists, founded mainly for the purpose of
abolishing pernicious insects.
Phileas Fogg was a
member of the Reform, and that was all.
The way in which he got
admission to this exclusive club was simple enough.
He was recommended by
the Barings, with whom he had an open credit. His cheques were regularly paid
at sight from his account current, which was always flush.
Was Phileas Fogg rich?
Undoubtedly. But those who knew him best could not imagine how he had made his
fortune, and Mr. Fogg was the last person to whom to apply for the information.
He was not lavish, nor, on the contrary, avaricious; for, whenever he knew that
money was needed for a noble, useful, or benevolent purpose, he supplied it
quietly and sometimes anonymously. He was, in short, the least communicative of
men. He talked very little, and seemed all the more mysterious for his taciturn
manner. His daily habits were quite open to observation; but whatever he did
was so exactly the same thing that he had always done before, that the wits of
the curious were fairly puzzled.
Had he travelled? It was
likely, for no one seemed to know the world more familiarly; there was no spot
so secluded that he did not appear to have an intimate acquaintance with it. He
often corrected, with a few clear words, the thousand conjectures advanced by
members of the club as to lost and unheard-of travellers, pointing out the true
probabilities, and seeming as if gifted with a sort of second sight, so often
did events justify his predictions. He must have travelled everywhere, at least
in the spirit.
It was at least certain
that Phileas Fogg had not absented himself from London for many years. Those
who were honoured by a better acquaintance with him than the rest, declared
that nobody could pretend to have ever seen him anywhere else. His sole
pastimes were reading the papers and playing whist. He often won at this game,
which, as a silent one, harmonised with his nature; but his winnings never went
into his purse, being reserved as a fund for his charities. Mr. Fogg played,
not to win, but for the sake of playing. The game was in his eyes a contest, a
struggle with a difficulty, yet a motionless, unwearying struggle, congenial to
his tastes.
Phileas Fogg was not
known to have either wife or children, which may happen to the most honest
people; either relatives or near friends, which is certainly more unusual. He
lived alone in his house in Saville Row, whither none penetrated. A single
domestic sufficed to serve him. He breakfasted and dined at the club, at hours
mathematically fixed, in the same room, at the same table, never taking his
meals with other members, much less bringing a guest with him; and went home at
exactly midnight, only to retire at once to bed. He never used the cosy
chambers which the Reform provides for its favoured members. He passed ten
hours out of the twenty-four in Saville Row, either in sleeping or making his
toilet. When he chose to take a walk it was with a regular step in the entrance
hall with its mosaic flooring, or in the circular gallery with its dome
supported by twenty red porphyry Ionic columns, and illumined by blue painted
windows. When he breakfasted or dined all the resources of the club—its
kitchens and pantries, its buttery and dairy—aided to crowd his table with
their most succulent stores; he was served by the gravest waiters, in dress
coats, and shoes with swan-skin soles, who proffered the viands in special
porcelain, and on the finest linen; club decanters, of a lost mould, contained
his sherry, his port, and his cinnamon-spiced claret; while his beverages were
refreshingly cooled with ice, brought at great cost from the American lakes.
If to live in this style
is to be eccentric, it must be confessed that there is something good in
eccentricity.
The mansion in Saville
Row, though not sumptuous, was exceedingly comfortable. The habits of its
occupant were such as to demand but little from the sole domestic, but Phileas
Fogg required him to be almost superhumanly prompt and regular. On this very
2nd of October he had dismissed James Forster, because that luckless youth had
brought him shaving-water at eighty-four degrees Fahrenheit instead of
eighty-six; and he was awaiting his successor, who was due at the house between
eleven and half-past.
Phileas Fogg was seated
squarely in his armchair, his feet close together like those of a grenadier on
parade, his hands resting on his knees, his body straight, his head erect; he
was steadily watching a complicated clock which indicated the hours, the
minutes, the seconds, the days, the months, and the years. At exactly half-past
eleven Mr. Fogg would, according to his daily habit, quit Saville Row, and
repair to the Reform.
A rap at this moment
sounded on the door of the cosy apartment where Phileas Fogg was seated, and
James Forster, the dismissed servant, appeared.
“The new servant,” said
he.
A young man of thirty
advanced and bowed.
“You are a Frenchman, I
believe,” asked Phileas Fogg, “and your name is John?”
“Jean, if monsieur
pleases,” replied the newcomer, “Jean Passepartout, a surname which has clung
to me because I have a natural aptness for going out of one business into
another. I believe I’m honest, monsieur, but, to be outspoken, I’ve had several
trades. I’ve been an itinerant singer, a circus-rider, when I used to vault
like Leotard, and dance on a rope like Blondin. Then I got to be a professor of
gymnastics, so as to make better use of my talents; and then I was a sergeant
fireman at Paris, and assisted at many a big fire. But I quitted France five
years ago, and, wishing to taste the sweets of domestic life, took service as a
valet here in England. Finding myself out of place, and hearing that Monsieur
Phileas Fogg was the most exact and settled gentleman in the United Kingdom, I
have come to monsieur in the hope of living with him a tranquil life, and
forgetting even the name of Passepartout.”
“Passepartout suits me,”
responded Mr. Fogg. “You are well recommended to me; I hear a good report of
you. You know my conditions?”
“Yes, monsieur.”
“Good! What time is it?”
“Twenty-two minutes
after eleven,” returned Passepartout, drawing an enormous silver watch from the
depths of his pocket.
“You are too slow,” said
Mr. Fogg.
“Pardon me, monsieur, it
is impossible—”
“You are four minutes
too slow. No matter; it’s enough to mention the error. Now from this moment,
twenty-nine minutes after eleven, a.m., this Wednesday, 2nd October, you are in
my service.”
Phileas Fogg got up,
took his hat in his left hand, put it on his head with an automatic motion, and
went off without a word.
Passepartout heard the
street door shut once; it was his new master going out. He heard it shut again;
it was his predecessor, James Forster, departing in his turn. Passepartout
remained alone in the house in Saville Row.
3/29-a Tuesday-AWED-Ch. 1 of 37=
1q Which is "the master (boss) & which is "the man"?
Answer= "Phileas Fogg" is
"the master" & "Passepartout" is "the man."
2q What is "Passepartout" 's 1st name?
Answer= "Jean"
3q Where is "Passepartout" originally from?
Answer= "France."
4q Where is "Phileas Fogg" from?
Answer= "the UK "(United Kingdom, England)
5q When did "Passepartout" leave "France"?
Answer= "5 years ago."
BQ Where in "England" did "Passepartout" live?
Answer="on Saville Row" (in
London,England, UK, now Savile Row, known for its traditional tailoring for
men.
3/30
CHAPTER II.
IN WHICH PASSEPARTOUT IS CONVINCED THAT HE HAS AT LAST FOUND HIS IDEAL
“Faith,” muttered
Passepartout, somewhat flurried, “I’ve seen people at Madame Tussaud’s as
lively as my new master!”
Madame Tussaud’s
“people,” let it be said, are of wax, and are much visited in London; speech is
all that is wanting to make them human.
During his brief
interview with Mr. Fogg, Passepartout had been carefully observing him. He
appeared to be a man about forty years of age, with fine, handsome features,
and a tall, well-shaped figure; his hair and whiskers were light, his forehead
compact and unwrinkled, his face rather pale, his teeth magnificent. His
countenance possessed in the highest degree what physiognomists call “repose in
action,” a quality of those who act rather than talk. Calm and phlegmatic, with
a clear eye, Mr. Fogg seemed a perfect type of that English composure which
Angelica Kauffmann has so skilfully represented on canvas. Seen in the various
phases of his daily life, he gave the idea of being perfectly well-balanced, as
exactly regulated as a Leroy chronometer. Phileas Fogg was, indeed, exactitude
personified, and this was betrayed even in the expression of his very hands and
feet; for in men, as well as in animals, the limbs themselves are expressive of
the passions.
He was so exact that he
was never in a hurry, was always ready, and was economical alike of his steps
and his motions. He never took one step too many, and always went to his
destination by the shortest cut; he made no superfluous gestures, and was never
seen to be moved or agitated. He was the most deliberate person in the world,
yet always reached his destination at the exact moment.
He lived alone, and, so
to speak, outside of every social relation; and as he knew that in this world
account must be taken of friction, and that friction retards, he never rubbed
against anybody.
As for Passepartout, he
was a true Parisian of Paris. Since he had abandoned his own country for
England, taking service as a valet, he had in vain searched for a master after
his own heart. Passepartout was by no means one of those pert dunces depicted
by Molière with a bold gaze and a nose held high in the air; he was an honest
fellow, with a pleasant face, lips a trifle protruding, soft-mannered and
serviceable, with a good round head, such as one likes to see on the shoulders
of a friend. His eyes were blue, his complexion rubicund, his figure almost
portly and well-built, his body muscular, and his physical powers fully
developed by the exercises of his younger days. His brown hair was somewhat
tumbled; for, while the ancient sculptors are said to have known eighteen
methods of arranging Minerva’s tresses, Passepartout was familiar with but one
of dressing his own: three strokes of a large-tooth comb completed his toilet.
It would be rash to
predict how Passepartout’s lively nature would agree with Mr. Fogg. It was impossible
to tell whether the new servant would turn out as absolutely methodical as his
master required; experience alone could solve the question. Passepartout had
been a sort of vagrant in his early years, and now yearned for repose; but so
far he had failed to find it, though he had already served in ten English
houses. But he could not take root in any of these; with chagrin, he found his
masters invariably whimsical and irregular, constantly running about the
country, or on the look-out for adventure. His last master, young Lord
Longferry, Member of Parliament, after passing his nights in the Haymarket
taverns, was too often brought home in the morning on policemen’s shoulders.
Passepartout, desirous of respecting the gentleman whom he served, ventured a
mild remonstrance on such conduct; which, being ill-received, he took his
leave. Hearing that Mr. Phileas Fogg was looking for a servant, and that his
life was one of unbroken regularity, that he neither travelled nor stayed from
home overnight, he felt sure that this would be the place he was after. He
presented himself, and was accepted, as has been seen.
At half-past eleven,
then, Passepartout found himself alone in the house in Saville Row. He began
its inspection without delay, scouring it from cellar to garret. So clean,
well-arranged, solemn a mansion pleased him; it seemed to him like a snail’s
shell, lighted and warmed by gas, which sufficed for both these purposes. When
Passepartout reached the second story he recognised at once the room which he
was to inhabit, and he was well satisfied with it. Electric bells and
speaking-tubes afforded communication with the lower stories; while on the
mantel stood an electric clock, precisely like that in Mr. Fogg’s bedchamber,
both beating the same second at the same instant. “That’s good, that’ll do,”
said Passepartout to himself.
He suddenly observed,
hung over the clock, a card which, upon inspection, proved to be a programme of
the daily routine of the house. It comprised all that was required of the servant,
from eight in the morning, exactly at which hour Phileas Fogg rose, till
half-past eleven, when he left the house for the Reform Club—all the details of
service, the tea and toast at twenty-three minutes past eight, the
shaving-water at thirty-seven minutes past nine, and the toilet at twenty
minutes before ten. Everything was regulated and foreseen that was to be done
from half-past eleven a.m. till midnight, the hour at which the methodical
gentleman retired.
Mr. Fogg’s wardrobe was
amply supplied and in the best taste. Each pair of trousers, coat, and vest
bore a number, indicating the time of year and season at which they were in
turn to be laid out for wearing; and the same system was applied to the
master’s shoes. In short, the house in Saville Row, which must have been a very
temple of disorder and unrest under the illustrious but dissipated Sheridan,
was cosiness, comfort, and method idealised. There was no study, nor were there
books, which would have been quite useless to Mr. Fogg; for at the Reform two
libraries, one of general literature and the other of law and politics, were at
his service. A moderate-sized safe stood in his bedroom, constructed so as to
defy fire as well as burglars; but Passepartout found neither arms nor hunting
weapons anywhere; everything betrayed the most tranquil and peaceable habits.
Having scrutinised the
house from top to bottom, he rubbed his hands, a broad smile overspread his
features, and he said joyfully, “This is just what I wanted! Ah, we shall get
on together, Mr. Fogg and I! What a domestic and regular gentleman! A real
machine; well, I don’t mind serving a machine.”
3/30-a
Wednesday-AWED-Ch. 2 of 37=
1q What has "Passepartout" at last found?
Answer= "his ideal."
2q What was special about "Mr. Fogg's wardrobe" (clothing)?
Answer= they were
numbered.
3q Who had "no books"?
Answer= "Mr. Fogg"
4q How did "Mr. Fogg" read books?
Answer= he went to "2 libraries."
5q What did they have at these libraries?
Answer="1 of general literature" & "1 of
law & politics."
BQ What stood "in his bedroom"?
Answer= "a moderate sized safe."
3/31
CHAPTER III.
IN WHICH A CONVERSATION TAKES PLACE WHICH SEEMS LIKELY TO COST PHILEAS FOGG
DEAR
Phileas Fogg, having
shut the door of his house at half-past eleven, and having put his right foot
before his left five hundred and seventy-five times, and his left foot before
his right five hundred and seventy-six times, reached the Reform Club, an imposing
edifice in Pall Mall, which could not have cost less than three millions. He
repaired at once to the dining-room, the nine windows of which open upon a
tasteful garden, where the trees were already gilded with an autumn colouring;
and took his place at the habitual table, the cover of which had already been
laid for him. His breakfast consisted of a side-dish, a broiled fish with
Reading sauce, a scarlet slice of roast beef garnished with mushrooms, a
rhubarb and gooseberry tart, and a morsel of Cheshire cheese, the whole being
washed down with several cups of tea, for which the Reform is famous. He rose
at thirteen minutes to one, and directed his steps towards the large hall, a
sumptuous apartment adorned with lavishly-framed paintings. A flunkey handed
him an uncut Times, which he proceeded to cut with a skill which
betrayed familiarity with this delicate operation. The perusal of this paper
absorbed Phileas Fogg until a quarter before four, whilst the Standard,
his next task, occupied him till the dinner hour. Dinner passed as breakfast
had done, and Mr. Fogg re-appeared in the reading-room and sat down to
the Pall Mall at twenty minutes before six. Half an hour later
several members of the Reform came in and drew up to the fireplace, where a
coal fire was steadily burning. They were Mr. Fogg’s usual partners at whist:
Andrew Stuart, an engineer; John Sullivan and Samuel Fallentin, bankers; Thomas
Flanagan, a brewer; and Gauthier Ralph, one of the Directors of the Bank of
England—all rich and highly respectable personages, even in a club which
comprises the princes of English trade and finance.
“Well, Ralph,” said
Thomas Flanagan, “what about that robbery?”
“Oh,” replied Stuart,
“the Bank will lose the money.”
“On the contrary,” broke
in Ralph, “I hope we may put our hands on the robber. Skilful detectives have
been sent to all the principal ports of America and the Continent, and he’ll be
a clever fellow if he slips through their fingers.”
“But have you got the
robber’s description?” asked Stuart.
“In the first place, he
is no robber at all,” returned Ralph, positively.
“What! a fellow who
makes off with fifty-five thousand pounds, no robber?”
“No.”
“Perhaps he’s a
manufacturer, then.”
“The Daily
Telegraph says that he is a gentleman.”
It was Phileas Fogg,
whose head now emerged from behind his newspapers, who made this remark. He
bowed to his friends, and entered into the conversation. The affair which
formed its subject, and which was town talk, had occurred three days before at
the Bank of England. A package of banknotes, to the value of fifty-five
thousand pounds, had been taken from the principal cashier’s table, that
functionary being at the moment engaged in registering the receipt of three
shillings and sixpence. Of course, he could not have his eyes everywhere. Let
it be observed that the Bank of England reposes a touching confidence in the
honesty of the public. There are neither guards nor gratings to protect its
treasures; gold, silver, banknotes are freely exposed, at the mercy of the
first comer. A keen observer of English customs relates that, being in one of
the rooms of the Bank one day, he had the curiosity to examine a gold ingot
weighing some seven or eight pounds. He took it up, scrutinised it, passed it
to his neighbour, he to the next man, and so on until the ingot, going from
hand to hand, was transferred to the end of a dark entry; nor did it return to
its place for half an hour. Meanwhile, the cashier had not so much as raised
his head. But in the present instance things had not gone so smoothly. The
package of notes not being found when five o’clock sounded from the ponderous
clock in the “drawing office,” the amount was passed to the account of profit
and loss. As soon as the robbery was discovered, picked detectives hastened off
to Liverpool, Glasgow, Havre, Suez, Brindisi, New York, and other ports,
inspired by the proffered reward of two thousand pounds, and five per cent. on
the sum that might be recovered. Detectives were also charged with narrowly
watching those who arrived at or left London by rail, and a judicial
examination was at once entered upon.
There were real grounds
for supposing, as the Daily Telegraph said, that the thief did
not belong to a professional band. On the day of the robbery a well-dressed
gentleman of polished manners, and with a well-to-do air, had been observed
going to and fro in the paying room where the crime was committed. A
description of him was easily procured and sent to the detectives; and some
hopeful spirits, of whom Ralph was one, did not despair of his apprehension.
The papers and clubs were full of the affair, and everywhere people were
discussing the probabilities of a successful pursuit; and the Reform Club was
especially agitated, several of its members being Bank officials.
Ralph would not concede
that the work of the detectives was likely to be in vain, for he thought that
the prize offered would greatly stimulate their zeal and activity. But Stuart
was far from sharing this confidence; and, as they placed themselves at the
whist-table, they continued to argue the matter. Stuart and Flanagan played
together, while Phileas Fogg had Fallentin for his partner. As the game
proceeded the conversation ceased, excepting between the rubbers, when it
revived again.
“I maintain,” said
Stuart, “that the chances are in favour of the thief, who must be a shrewd
fellow.”
“Well, but where can he
fly to?” asked Ralph. “No country is safe for him.”
“Pshaw!”
“Where could he go,
then?”
“Oh, I don’t know that.
The world is big enough.”
“It was once,” said Phileas
Fogg, in a low tone. “Cut, sir,” he added, handing the cards to Thomas
Flanagan.
The discussion fell
during the rubber, after which Stuart took up its thread.
“What do you mean by
‘once’? Has the world grown smaller?”
“Certainly,” returned
Ralph. “I agree with Mr. Fogg. The world has grown smaller, since a man can now
go round it ten times more quickly than a hundred years ago. And that is why
the search for this thief will be more likely to succeed.”
“And also why the thief
can get away more easily.”
“Be so good as to play,
Mr. Stuart,” said Phileas Fogg.
But the incredulous
Stuart was not convinced, and when the hand was finished, said eagerly: “You
have a strange way, Ralph, of proving that the world has grown smaller. So,
because you can go round it in three months—”
“In eighty days,”
interrupted Phileas Fogg.
“That is true,
gentlemen,” added John Sullivan. “Only eighty days, now that the section
between Rothal and Allahabad, on the Great Indian Peninsula Railway, has been
opened. Here is the estimate made by the Daily Telegraph:—
From London to
Suez viâ Mont Cenis and Brindisi, by rail and steamboats
................. 7 days
From Suez to Bombay, by steamer .................... 13 ”
From Bombay to Calcutta, by rail ................... 3 ”
From Calcutta to Hong Kong, by steamer ............. 13 ”
From Hong Kong to Yokohama (Japan), by steamer ..... 6 ”
From Yokohama to San Francisco, by steamer ......... 22 ”
From San Francisco to New York, by rail ............. 7 ”
From New York to London, by steamer and rail ........ 9 ”
-------
Total ............................................ 80 days.”
“Yes, in eighty days!”
exclaimed Stuart, who in his excitement made a false deal. “But that doesn’t
take into account bad weather, contrary winds, shipwrecks, railway accidents,
and so on.”
“All included,” returned
Phileas Fogg, continuing to play despite the discussion.
“But suppose the Hindoos
or Indians pull up the rails,” replied Stuart; “suppose they stop the trains,
pillage the luggage-vans, and scalp the passengers!”
“All included,” calmly
retorted Fogg; adding, as he threw down the cards, “Two trumps.”
Stuart, whose turn it
was to deal, gathered them up, and went on: “You are right, theoretically, Mr.
Fogg, but practically—”
“Practically also, Mr.
Stuart.”
“I’d like to see you do
it in eighty days.”
“It depends on you.
Shall we go?”
“Heaven preserve me! But
I would wager four thousand pounds that such a journey, made under these
conditions, is impossible.”
“Quite possible, on the
contrary,” returned Mr. Fogg.
“Well, make it, then!”
“The journey round the
world in eighty days?”
“Yes.”
“I should like nothing
better.”
“When?”
“At once. Only I warn
you that I shall do it at your expense.”
“It’s absurd!” cried
Stuart, who was beginning to be annoyed at the persistency of his friend.
“Come, let’s go on with the game.”
“Deal over again, then,”
said Phileas Fogg. “There’s a false deal.”
Stuart took up the pack
with a feverish hand; then suddenly put them down again.
“Well, Mr. Fogg,” said
he, “it shall be so: I will wager the four thousand on it.”
“Calm yourself, my dear
Stuart,” said Fallentin. “It’s only a joke.”
“When I say I’ll wager,”
returned Stuart, “I mean it.”
“All right,” said Mr.
Fogg; and, turning to the others, he continued: “I have a deposit of twenty
thousand at Baring’s which I will willingly risk upon it.”
“Twenty thousand
pounds!” cried Sullivan. “Twenty thousand pounds, which you would lose by a
single accidental delay!”
“The unforeseen does not
exist,” quietly replied Phileas Fogg.
“But, Mr. Fogg, eighty
days are only the estimate of the least possible time in which the journey can
be made.”
“A well-used minimum
suffices for everything.”
“But, in order not to
exceed it, you must jump mathematically from the trains upon the steamers, and
from the steamers upon the trains again.”
“I will
jump—mathematically.”
“You are joking.”
“A true Englishman
doesn’t joke when he is talking about so serious a thing as a wager,” replied
Phileas Fogg, solemnly. “I will bet twenty thousand pounds against anyone who
wishes that I will make the tour of the world in eighty days or less; in
nineteen hundred and twenty hours, or a hundred and fifteen thousand two
hundred minutes. Do you accept?”
“We accept,” replied
Messrs. Stuart, Fallentin, Sullivan, Flanagan, and Ralph, after consulting each
other.
“Good,” said Mr. Fogg.
“The train leaves for Dover at a quarter before nine. I will take it.”
“This very evening?”
asked Stuart.
“This very evening,”
returned Phileas Fogg. He took out and consulted a pocket almanac, and added,
“As today is Wednesday, the 2nd of October, I shall be due in London in this
very room of the Reform Club, on Saturday, the 21st of December, at a quarter
before nine p.m.; or else the twenty thousand pounds, now deposited in my name
at Baring’s, will belong to you, in fact and in right, gentlemen. Here is a
cheque for the amount.”
A memorandum of the
wager was at once drawn up and signed by the six parties, during which Phileas
Fogg preserved a stoical composure. He certainly did not bet to win, and had
only staked the twenty thousand pounds, half of his fortune, because he foresaw
that he might have to expend the other half to carry out this difficult, not to
say unattainable, project. As for his antagonists, they seemed much agitated;
not so much by the value of their stake, as because they had some scruples
about betting under conditions so difficult to their friend.
The clock struck seven,
and the party offered to suspend the game so that Mr. Fogg might make his
preparations for departure.
“I am quite ready now,”
was his tranquil response. “Diamonds are trumps: be so good as to play,
gentlemen.”
3/31-a
Thursday-AWED-Ch. 3 of 37=
1q What kind of "conversation" did they have?
Answer= "one that was likely to
cost Phileas Fogg dear" (was expensive)
2q How long would the trip from "London, UK to (the) Suez" (Canal) be?
Answer= "7
days"
3q How long would the trip from "Calcutta (now Kolkatta) to Hong Kong" be?
Answer= "13
days"
4q How long would the trip from "New York to London" be?
Answer= "9 days"
5q In total, how long would it take them to go around the world?
Answer= "80 days"
BQ What "doesn't it take into account"?
Answer= "bad weather, contrary winds,
shipwrecks, railway accidents, etc."
Comments
Post a Comment